You are on page 1of 188

Installation

Base Transceiver Station Equipment


IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II
A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Important Notice on Product Safety


DANGER - RISK OF ELECTRICAL SHOCK OR DEATH - FOLLOW ALL INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS.
The system complies with the standard EN 60950 / IEC 60950. All equipment connected to the system must
comply with the applicable safety standards.
Hazardous voltages are present at the AC power supply lines in this electrical equipment. Some components may
also have high operating temperatures.
Failure to observe and follow all installation and safety instructions can result in serious personal injury
or property damage.
Therefore, only trained and qualified personnel may install and maintain the system.

The same text in German:


Wichtiger Hinweis zur Produktsicherheit
LEBENSGEFAHR - BEACHTEN SIE ALLE INSTALLATIONSHINWEISE.
Das System entspricht den Anforderungen der EN 60950 / IEC 60950. Alle an das System angeschlossenen
Gerte mssen die zutreffenden Sicherheitsbestimmungen erfllen.
In diesen Anlagen stehen die Netzversorgungsleitungen unter gefhrlicher Spannung. Einige Komponenten
knnen auch eine hohe Betriebstemperatur aufweisen.
Nichtbeachtung der Installations- und Sicherheitshinweise kann zu schweren Krperverletzungen oder
Sachschden fhren.
Deshalb darf nur geschultes und qualifiziertes Personal das System installieren und warten.

Caution:
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with EN 301489. Its class of conformity is defined in table
A30808-X3247-X910-*-7618, which is shipped with each product. This class also corresponds to the limits for a
Class A digital device, pursuant to part 15 of the FCC Rules.
These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment is
operated in a commercial environment.
This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the relevant standards referenced in the manual Guide to Documentation, may cause harmful interference to radio communications.
For system installations it is strictly required to choose all installation sites according to national and local requirements concerning construction rules and static load capacities of buildings and roofs.
For all sites, in particular in residential areas it is mandatory to observe all respectively applicable electromagnetic
field / force (EMF) limits. Otherwise harmful personal interference is possible.

Trademarks:
All designations used in this document can be trademarks, the use of which by third parties for their own purposes
could violate the rights of their owners.

Copyright (C) Siemens AG 2006.


Issued by the Communications Group
Hofmannstrae 51
D-81359 Mnchen
Technical modifications possible.
Technical specifications and features are binding only insofar as
they are specifically and expressly agreed upon in a written contract.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Reason for Update


Summary:
Seventeenth Edition, release-independent, valid from starting Release BR 6.0
Details:
Chapter / Section

Reason for Update

2.7.3

New Battery Tray with MK:BATTFIXCB included

Issue History
Issue

Date of Issue

Reason for Update

06/2002

First Edition

07/2002

Second Edition

09/2002

Third Edition

11/2002

Fourth Edition

04/2003

Fifth Edition

12/2003

Sixth Edition

02/2004

Seventh Edition

03/2004

Eighth Edition

05/2004

Ninth Edition

10

08/2004

Tenth Edition

11

01/2005

Eleventh Edition

12

04/2005

Twelfth Edition

13

07/2005

Thirteenth Edition

14

09/2005

Fourteenth Edition

15

11/2005

Fifteenth Edition

16

03/2006

Sixteenth Edition

17

04/2006

Seventeenth Edition

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

This document consists of a total of 188 pages. All pages are issue 17.

Contents
1
1.1
1.2
1.3

Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Purpose of the Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installation Prerequisites. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handling of the Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

15
15
15
16

2
2.1
2.2
2.3
2.4
2.4.1
2.4.1.1
2.4.1.2
2.4.1.3
2.4.1.4
2.5
2.5.1
2.5.2
2.5.3
2.5.4
2.5.5
2.5.5.1
2.5.5.2
2.5.6
2.5.7
2.6
2.6.1
2.6.2
2.6.3
2.6.4
2.6.4.1
2.6.4.2
2.6.4.3
2.6.4.4
2.6.5
2.6.6
2.6.7
2.6.8
2.6.9
2.6.10
2.6.11
2.6.12
2.6.13
2.6.13.1

Base Station Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .


Position in the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Site Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Site Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Construction Overview of the BS-Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rack Configuration of different BS-Variants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rack Configurations BS-240. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rack Configurations of the BS-240 II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rack Configurations for BS-240XL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rack Configurations for BS-240XL II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Equipment Delivery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Preliminary Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rack mounted on a Pallet. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rack shipped in a Crate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Unpacking of Modules and Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rack Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Setup of Earthquake Mounting Kit for BS-240 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Setup of Earthquake Mounting Kit for BS-240XL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Setup of Earthquake Mounting Kit for BS-240 II / 240XL II. . . . . . . . . . . . .
Back-to-back Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Cabling Activities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ground and AC- Power Supply Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ground and DC- Power Supply Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Abis-Interface - PCM Link Terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Abis-Interface for 120 Ohm Cable Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Abis-Interface with ABISCONCX / OVPTCOAX 75 Ohm . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Abis-Interface without ABISCON / OVPT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Monitoring Interfaces of ABISCON and OVPT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Alarm Collection Terminal - external Alarm Sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installation of the Mounting Kit OPEXAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installation of the MK:OPEXAL10V1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Alarm Protection for ACTM (EAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Alarm Collection Terminal ACTC - internal Alarms / DC Supply. . . . . . . . .
Alarm Collection Terminal ACTC-3 - internal Alarms / DC Supply . . . . . . .
Alarm Collection Terminal ACTC-4 - internal Alarms / DC Supply . . . . . . .
Local Maintenance Terminal (LMT) Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Antenna Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Preparation of Antenna Jumper Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

17
17
17
18
18
20
21
23
23
26
27
27
27
28
30
31
36
37
40
43
50
50
58
60
62
62
65
67
69
71
73
76
80
84
87
89
92
93
93

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.6.14
2.6.14.1
2.6.14.2
2.7
2.7.1
2.7.2
2.7.3
2.7.3.1
2.7.3.2
2.7.3.3
2.7.4
2.7.4.1
2.7.4.2
2.7.4.3
2.7.4.4
2.7.4.5
2.7.4.6
2.7.4.7
2.7.4.8
2.7.4.9
2.7.4.10
2.7.4.11
2.7.5
2.7.5.1
2.7.5.2
2.7.5.3
2.7.5.4
2.7.5.5
2.7.5.6
2.7.5.7
2.7.5.8
2.7.5.9
2.7.5.10
2.7.5.11
2.7.5.12
2.7.6
2.7.6.1
2.7.7
2.7.7.1
2.7.7.2
2.8
2.9
2.9.1
2.10
2.10.1
2.10.2
2.10.3

Installation of the Tower Mounted Amplifier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99


Installation of the TMADV1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Installation of the STMAx / DTMAx . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Rack Completion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Preparation of the Top Cover. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Overview of Battery Sets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Installation of Backup Batteries in Service Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Installation of Backup Batteries Type Excide. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Installation of Backup Batteries Type Oerlicon . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Install Backup Batteries Type EnerSys / Hawker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Inter-Rack Cable Routing (standard Configuration) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Battery Cabling of BS-240 / 240XL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Battery Cabling for BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADPAV3). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Battery Cabling for BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADP-2V1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Battery Alarm Cable Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
DC Cabling between the Racks (BS-240 / 240XL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
DC Connections BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADPAV3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
-48V DC Connections BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADP-2V1). . . . . . . . . . . 133
-48 V DC for Link Equipment of BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADPAV3). . . . 134
-48 V DC for Link Equipment of BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADP-2V1) . . . 135
CAN-Bus Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
SELIC-Cabling between the Racks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Inter-Rack Cabling (mixed Configuration) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Battery Cabling between BS-240 and BS-240 II Racks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Battery Cabling between BS-240XL and BS-240XL II Racks . . . . . . . . . . 144
Battery Cabling Activities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
-48V DC Cabling BS-240 / S1 and BS-240 II / Base, Extension . . . . . . . . 147
-48V DC Cabling BS-240 II / S1A and BS-240 / Base, Extension . . . . . . 148
-48V DC Cabling BS-240 / S1 and BS-240 II / S2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
DC Cabling BS-240 II / S1A and BS-240 / S2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
DC Cabling BS-240XL / S1 and BS-240XL II / Base, Extension . . . . . . . . 153
DC Cabling BS-240XL II / S1A and BS-240XL / Base, Extension . . . . . . . 154
DC Cabling BS-240XL / S1 and BS-240XL II / S2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
DC Cabling BS-240XL II / S1A and BS-240XL / S2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
SELIC-Cabling between the Racks (mixed Configuration) . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
Combination of Racks with different Heights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
BS-240 II / S1A with BS-240XL II / Extension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
Installation of Link Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Installation of Microwave Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
Installation of NTPM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Installation of the Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Nonstandard Installation Works . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Installation of the AC/DC Frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Setup of System Cabling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
System Cabling with semi-rigid Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
System Cabling with Flexi-Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Terminators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.11
2.11.1

Post Installation Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180


Disposal of Electrical and Electronic Equipment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180

3
3.1
3.2
3.3
3.4
3.5

Appendix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installation Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ancillary Material. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Technical Data of BS-240/240XL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuration Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Checklist for Base Station Installation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Abbreviations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

181
181
181
182
184
185

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Illustrations
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.

1.1
1.2
1.3
2.1
2.2
2.3
2.4
2.5
2.6
2.7
2.8
2.9
2.10
2.11
2.12
2.13
2.14
2.15
2.16
2.17
2.18
2.19
2.20
2.21
2.22
2.23
2.24
2.25
2.26
2.27
2.28
2.29
2.30
2.31
2.32
2.33
2.34
2.35
2.36
2.37
2.38
2.39
2.40

ESD Symbol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
ESD jack for wrist strap connection of BS-240 / 240XL . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
ESD press-stud for wrist strap connection of BS-240 II / 240 XL II . . . . 16
Position of the Base Station within the SBS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Site configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Rack types of the BS-240 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Service1 rack configurations of the BS-240 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Service2 rack configurations of the BS-240 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Types of BS-240 II racks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Types of BS-240XL racks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Types of BS-240XL II Racks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
ShockwatchTM-label and TiltwatchTM-label. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Rack mounted on the pallet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Dismounting the rack from the pallet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Removal of the straps, opening of the top cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Removal of the packing material. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Opening of the PE-wrap, lifting straps around the rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Unpacking of the battery sets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Removal of top cover for crane eye access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Opening of rack door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Removal of the top cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Guideline for crane transport . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Space necessary for installation of Base Station rack variants . . . . . . . 34
Adjusting and fixing of the rack feet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Floor and wall mounting of the racks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Earthquake mounting kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Drilling sketch for earthquake mounting kit (2 racks) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Drilling sketch for earthquake mounting kit (2 racks) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Parts of the earthquake mounting kit for the BS-240XL . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Mounting of Pos. 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Mounting of stiffening parts (1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Mounting of stiffening parts (2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Parts of the earthquake kit S3086-K4119-X . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Double claw for the rear feet in mounted position. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Claws for the front feet before mounting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Drilling sketch for the earthquake mounting kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
Back-to-back configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Side-by-side configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Back-to-back configuration with Extension1 and Extension2 . . . . . . . . 44
Back-to-back configuration with Service1 and Service2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Interfaces on the top of the BS-240 Base Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Interfaces on the top of the BS-240 Extension Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Interfaces on the top of the BS-240/240XL Service1Rack . . . . . . . . . . . 51

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

2.41
2.42
2.43
2.44
2.45
2.46
2.47
2.48
2.49
2.50
2.51
2.52
2.53
2.54
2.55
2.56
2.57
2.58
2.59
2.60
2.61
2.62
2.63
2.64
2.65
2.66
2.67
2.68
2.69
2.70
2.71
2.72
2.73
2.74
2.75
2.76
2.77
2.78
2.79
2.80
2.81
2.82
2.83
2.84

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Interfaces on the top of the BS-240/240XL Service2 Rack . . . . . . . . . .


Interfaces on the top of the BS-240XL Base Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Interfaces on the top of the BS-240XL Extension Rack. . . . . . . . . . . . .
Interfaces on the top of the BS-240 II Base Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Interfaces on the top of the BS-240 II Extension Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Interfaces on the EMI-Panel of the BS-240 II/240XL II Service1 Rack .
Interfaces on the top of the BS-240 II /240XL II Service2 Rack. . . . . . .
Interfaces on the top of the BS-240XL II Base Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Interfaces on the top of the BS-240XL II Extension Rack . . . . . . . . . . .
Locations of the connectors for external cables. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ground and AC mains connections (example) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Wiring example of the 230 Vac terminal block (BS-240 Service1 Rack)
Ground- and power supply connections with -48V DC . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Terminal block for -48 V DC input of MSU (BS-240) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Preparation of a PCM-cable, 120 impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fastening of PCM cables at OVPT / ABISCON (120 ) . . . . . . . . . . . .
Abis interface PCM0 Pin Assignment, 120 Ohm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Abis interface PCM1 Pin Assignment, 120 Ohm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
OVPTCOAX with 1,0/2,3 coaxial connectors, 75 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Monitoring interfaces for PCM lines of ABISCON / OVPT . . . . . . . . . . .
ACTM terminal numbering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Contents of the MK:OPEXAL. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Drilling sketch for MK:OPEXAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Wall mounted MK:OPEXAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Routing of external alarm cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Assembly Guideline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ACTM, connection of the cables from OPEXAL10V1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Connector assignment of the OPEXAL10V1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Label with terminal assignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Mounting of the EAP on the top of the BS-240 II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Connector arrangement at ACTC (BS-240). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Connector arrangement at ACTC (BS-240XL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Connector arrangement at the ACTC-3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Connector arrangement at the ACTC-4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cell numbering (top view from the antenna pole) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tools for jumper fabrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Parts of the connector unit kit (example) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using the trimming tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Removal of isolation and deburring of inner conductor . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Removal of metal particles. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Assembly of the connector unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fixing of connector unit, removal of outer insulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handling of heat protection tape and shrink sleeve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Shrinkage and removal of visible heat protection tape . . . . . . . . . . . . .

52
52
53
53
54
54
55
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
64
65
69
71
73
74
74
75
76
76
79
79
80
84
86
87
89
93
94
94
95
95
95
96
96
96
97

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

10

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.

2.85
2.86
2.87
2.88
2.89
2.90
2.91
2.92
2.93
2.94
2.95
2.96
2.97
2.98
2.99
2.100
2.101
2.102
2.103

Max. dimensions of the antenna connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97


Opening of the cable feeding module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Antenna jumpers at the cable feeding module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Antenna jumpers at the cable feeding module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Position of TMA (DUAMCO combiner used). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Position of TMA (FICOM combiner used) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Configuration with HPDU, DUBIAS and TMA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Installation of TMA and DUBIAS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Bottom view of the TMADV1 (Single TMA). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
TMA with mounting brackets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Example of STMAx and DTMAx . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Rear side of STMAx and DTMAx (example) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Example of pole mounting with the STMAx ( . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Contents of the connection kits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Setup of EMC sealing stripes (BS-240 / 240XL). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Setup of EMC sealing contact springs (BS-240 II / 240XL II) . . . . . . . . 106
Connection of the racks (example with BS-240). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Paint retouch of the top cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Placement of the sealing profile tapes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108

Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.

2.104
2.105
2.106
2.107
2.108
2.109
2.110
2.111
2.112
2.113
2.114
2.115
2.116
2.117
2.118
2.119
2.120
2.121
2.122
2.123
2.124
2.125
2.126
2.127
2.128

Parts for battery fixing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110


Placement of the spacer strips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Preparation of the battery tray . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Battery tray with backup batteries type Excide. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Connection of backup battery set Excide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Contents of the air vent kit Excide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Assembly of the air vent kit Excide. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Connection of backup batteries (Co. Oerlicon) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Air vent system for Oerlicon battery set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Location of the Battery Breakers at the AD-Panel ADPAV3 . . . . . . . . . 117
Placement and connection of the batteries. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Detail of the connection of battery 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Parts of the air vent system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Routing of the air vent tubes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Connection between the batteries, battery cable connection . . . . . . . . 120
Terminal blocks for battery cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Overview of the battery cabling BS-240 / 240 XL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Example of battery cabling of BS-240XL II (S1A, ADPAV3). . . . . . . . . 124
Example of battery cabling of BS-240 II (S1A, ADPAV3) . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Overview of battery breakers in S1A / S2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Example of battery cabling of BS-240 II (S1A, ADP-2V1) . . . . . . . . . . 127
Example of battery cabling of BS-240XL II (S1A, ADP-2V1) . . . . . . . . 128
Battery alarm cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Routing of the DC power supply wires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
DC terminal block access of BS-240 / 240XL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

2.129
2.130
2.131
2.132
2.133
2.134
2.135
2.136
2.137
2.138
2.139
2.140
2.141
2.142
2.143
2.144
2.145
2.146
2.147
2.148
2.149
2.150
2.151
2.152
2.153
2.154
2.155
2.156
2.157
2.158
2.159
2.160
2.161
2.162
2.163
2.164
2.165
2.166
2.167
2.168
2.169
2.170
2.171
2.172

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Routing of DC cabling between the BS-240 racks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130


Routing of DC cabling between BS-240XL racks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
DC cabling between the BS-240 II / 240 XL II racks (S1A, ADPAV3) . 132
DC cabling between the BS-240 II / 240 XL II racks (S1A, ADP-2V1). 133
DC cabling for link equipment of BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADPAV3) 134
DC cabling for link equipment of BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADP-2V1) 135
DC cabling for link equipment of BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADP-2V1) 136
Location of CAN-Bus interfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Example for CAN-Bus cable connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Location of SELIC interfaces (BS-240) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
SELIC-cabling between the racks BS-240 / 240 II. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Location of SELIC interfaces (BS-240XL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
SELIC-cabling of BS-240XL / 240XL II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Adaptation of the top cover for interrack cable routing . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Example of Battery Cabling with BS-240 and BS-240 II Service Racks142
Example of Battery Cabling BS-240XL / S1 and BS-240XL II / S2 . . . 144
Battery Cables 110*/M and 111*/M . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
WAGO terminal for battery cabling at F:AC/DC. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
-48V DC connections BS-240 / S1 and BS-240II / Base and E1 . . . . . 147
DC cabling BS-240 II / S1A and BS-240 / Base, E1 (S1A, ADPAV3) . 148
DC cables from Service1A to Base and Extension1(S1A, ADP-2V1) . 149
DC cabling between BS-240 / S1 and BS-240 II / S2 racks . . . . . . . . 150
DC cables between BS-240II/ S1A and BS-240/S2 (S1A, ADPAV3) 151
DC cables between BS-240UII/S1A and BS-240/S2 (S1A, ADP-2V1) 152
DC connections between BS-240XL / S1 and BS-240XLII / Base, E1 153
DC connections between BS-240XLII / S1A and BS-240XL / Base, E1154
DC connections between BS-240XL / S1 and BS-240XL II / S2 . . . . . 155
DC connections between BS-240XL II/ S1A and BS-240XL / S2 . . . . 156
DC connection (BS-240 / S1A with BS-240XL II / Extension) . . . . . . . 158
(View A) Preparation of the DC cables at the cable feeding module . . 159
(View B) Cable connections to Ground and MSU:DC of Extension. . . 159
Mounting Kit for Link Equipment MK:LE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Cabling for link equipment (BS-240 / 240XL). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
Connection of the DC supply cables (cable no. 401). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
DC distribution block with microwave units in Service1A (BS-240 II) . 163
DC distribution block with microwave units in Service2 (BS-240 II). . . 163
Overview of microwave cabling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Overview of NTPM cabling variants. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Interfaces on frame F:NT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Fixing variants of the modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Handling of the lever mechanism. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Location of the code key no. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Components of the AC/DC frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Fitting of the air flaps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170

11

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.
Fig.

12

2.173
2.174
2.175
2.176
2.177
2.178
2.179
2.180
2.181
2.182
3.1

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Setup of the rubber sealing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171


Plug-in of the fan cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Air duct mounting, disconnection CAN-BUS cable no. 91 . . . . . . . . . . 172
Connection CAN-BUS and Interconnection Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
Cable Connections at AC/DC frame 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
Connection of DC and Battery Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Routing of the Battery Breaker Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Fitting of the fans, closing the AC/DC frame. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
Example of system cabling with semi-rigid cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
Example of system cabling with flexible cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Example for Configuration Overview (BS-240) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Tables
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.

2.1
2.2
2.3
2.4
2.5
2.6
2.7
2.8
2.9
2.10
2.11
2.12
2.13
2.14
2.15
2.16
2.17
2.18
2.19
2.20
2.21
2.22
2.23
2.24
2.25
2.26
2.27
2.28
2.29
2.30
2.31
2.32
2.33
2.34
2.35
2.36
2.37
2.38
2.39

Tab. 2.40
Tab. 2.41

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Frame equipping variants, BS-240XL Base and Extension Racks . . . . 24


Equipping variants, BS-240XL Service1 Rack. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Equipping variants, BS-240XL Service2 Rack. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Gap between Service2/1 and Service2/2 rack. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Gap between Extension1and Extension2 rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Gap between Base and Extension1 rack. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Gap between Service2/1 and Service1 rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Gap between Service1 and Base . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Interrack-cables without extension. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Types of flexible conduit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Pin Assignments of Abis interface PCM0, 75 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Pin Assignments of Abis interface PCM1, 75 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Pin Assignments of the PCM0 interface (SubD 25 connector) . . . . . . . 67
Pin Assignments of the PCM1 interface (SubD 25 connector) . . . . . . . 68
Pin Assignments of the monitoring interfaces PCM0. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Pin Assignments of the monitoring interfaces PCM1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Pin Assignments ACTM Connector X1...X4. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Pin Assignments ACTM Connector X5...X8. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Pin Assignments ACTM Connector X9, X10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
OPEXAL10V1 Module 0 connection at ACTM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
OPEXAL10V1 Module 1 connection at ACTM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Pin / Wire assignment EAP-cable 1 and 2 (Sub-37, female) . . . . . . . . . 81
Wire / Terminal assignment EAP-cable 2 at ACTM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Wire / Terminal assignment EAP-cable 1 at ACTM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
ACTC alarms for BS-240 rack types (not for BS-240XL). . . . . . . . . . . . 85
ACTC alarms for BS-240 XL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
ACTC alarms for BS-240 II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
ACTC alarms for BS-240XL II rack types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
ACTC-4 alarms for BS-240 II racks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
ACTC-4 alarms for BS-240 II racks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Pin Assignments of the LMT interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Pin Assignments of the LMT RJ45 interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Overview of backup battery sets (BS-240 / BS-240XL) . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Overview of backup battery sets BS-240II / BS-240XL II) . . . . . . . . . . 109
Selection of Slot ID (BS-240 / 240 XL). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
List of battery cables between the racks (BS-240) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
List of battery cables between the racks (BS-240XL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
List of temp-resistor cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
List of battery cables between the racks of BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A with
ADPAV3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Battery sensor cabling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Battery cables between the racks of BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADP-2V1)
126

13

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.

2.42
2.43
2.44
2.45

Tab. 2.46
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.

2.47
2.48
2.49
2.50
2.51
2.52
2.53
2.54
2.55

Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.

2.56
2.57
2.58
2.59

Tab. 2.60
Tab. 2.61
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.
Tab.

14

2.62
2.63
2.64
2.65
2.66
2.67
3.1
3.2

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Battery sensor cabling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127


List of DC cable connections between BS-240 racks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
DC cable connections between the BS-240XL racks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
DC cable connections between BS-240 II / 240XL II racks (S1A, ADPAV3)
132
DC cable connections between BS-240 II / 240XL II racks (S1A, ADP-2V1)
133
Cables for link equipment of BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADPAV3). . . . 134
DC cabling for link equipment of BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADP-2V1) 136
Example for CAN-Bus cabling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
List of SELIC-cabling BS-240 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
List of SELIC-cabling BS-240 II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
SELIC-cabling of BS-240XL and BS-240XL II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Battery Cable Kits for Connection BS-240 with BS-240 II S2 Racks . . 143
Overview of the Tempresistor Cables. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Battery Cables for BS-240XL Service1 with BS-240XL II Service2 Racks .
145
Overview of the Tempresistor Cables. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
Cables from Service1A to Base and Extension1/2 (S1A, ADPAV3) . . . 148
Cables from Service1A to Base and Extension 1/2 (S1A, ADP-2V1) . . 149
SELIC-cabling (mixed configuration without distance between cabinets). .
157
SELIC-cabling (mixed configuration with distance between cabinets) . 157
Pre-fabricated cables between OVPT/ABISCON and the microwave units
164
Pin Assignments of -48 V interface of frame F:NT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Pin Assignments of PCM-Input and -Output connector of frame F:NT . 167
Module HW Code Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Functionality of system cables BS-240 / 240 II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
Functionality of system cables BS-240XL / XL II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
BS-240 II / 240 XL II, flexible system cable types. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
Technical Data of BS-240 / 240 II / 240XL / 240 XL II . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
Checklist for BS-240/240XL Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

1 Introduction
!

Important!
The CE declaration of conformity for the product will be fulfilled if the setup and cabling
is undertaken in accordance with the specification in the manual and the documentation
listed there, such as mounting instructions, cable lists etc. Where necessary, projectspecific documentation should be taken into account.
Deviations from the specifications or independent changes during setup, such as use of
cable types with lower screening values, for example, can lead to the CE requirements
being violated. In such cases the CE declaration of conformity is invalidated and the responsibility passes to the person who has caused the deviations.
The applying technical standards are listed in the Guide to Documentation
(Siemens document number A30808-X3247-K52-*-7635).

1.1

Purpose of the Manual


This document is intended to provide the information necessary for the installation of the
BS-240 / BS-240 II and BS-240XL / BS-240XL II in the SBS Base Station System (BSS).
It contains a description of all the necessary steps to install the BTS on site and integrate
it into the required infrastructure. The document includes information on the following:
Equipment delivery
Preliminary checks
Unpacking the racks and devices
Rack installation
in addition to information regarding the connection of the base station to:
Power supply
PCM - Network
Site ground system
Receive / transmit antenna system
Alarm connections
Mechanical and electrical connection of the racks
For installation of equipment not supplied by Siemens (battery chargers, antennas, power supplies, microwave etc.) refer to site specific documentation or vendor instructions
provided with other equipment.

1.2

Installation Prerequisites
It is required that the installer pays attention to all relevant national EMC standards.
EMF standard relevant for the choice of the antenna, the placement of the antennas
and the max. output power of the BTS (cell coverage).
Use the correct material as described in this manual.
Installation according to the standards EN 50310 or ETS 300253, EN 50154 and the
hints in this manual.
The other equipment on site must be CE designated and must provide interfaces for
connecting of external cables conformable to EMC instructions.
The installation staff should have a basic knowledge of the relevant standards. The installation manual must be available for staff on site.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

15

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

1.3

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Handling of the Modules


All boards and modules must be handled with extreme care as each one contains electrostatically sensitive devices (ESD). The modules are marked with the ESD-label.

Fig. 1.1

ESD Symbol

These are sensitive to static discharge.


Notice:
Avoid handling the modules in a high-static environment.
When handling the modules, do not touch connector contacts.
An ground high-impedance wrist strap must be worn when handling modules.
Use the socket at the racks for wrist strap connection.
The modules must be transported in appropriate packaging.

16

Fig. 1.2

ESD jack for wrist strap connection of BS-240 / 240XL

Fig. 1.3

ESD press-stud for wrist strap connection of BS-240 II / 240 XL II

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2 Base Station Installation


2.1

Position in the System


The BS-240/240XL and BS-240 II / 240XL II interconnects the MS via the Um interface
with the trunk network via the Abis interface.

Um
interface

BTS

2.2

interface

BSC

Asub
interface

TRAU

A
interface

MSC

SBS

Mobile
Station
Fig. 2.1

Abis

Position of the Base Station within the SBS

Site Requirements
The installation site must fulfill installation rules according to ETS 300253 or EN 50310
and EN 50174.
The lightning protection measures must be in accordance with IEC 61312, IEC 61024
and IEC 61663 (in the future series IEC 62305-3 to IEC 62305-5) to achieve a lightning
protection zone 1 interface to the communication equipment.
With regard to explosion hazards, the installation room of the base transceiver station
with integral battery back-up system must be guarantee a continuous ventilation, to
keep the critical hydrogen concentration below 4% vol.
The cross section of the air inlet / outlet must be calculated in accordance to
IEC/EN50272-2.
The construction of the room in which the base transceiver station is to be housed must
be complete and the room in good condition and dry (the humidity must not exceed 60
%), heaters if necessary, should be placed inside the room.
The BS-240 / 240XL and BS-240 II / 240XL II are intended to be installed in an area with
restricted access.
It is important, that the installation site and the transportation route meets the valid floor
load requirements. If the floor load rating is unknown, be sure to find out with a building
engineer or another appropriate professional during the site acquisition.
Prior to the commencement of installation, the site must have been prepared as follows:
The installing room should be free from possible water ingress, frost and excessive
insect attacks.
Doors and windows must already have been installed and must be lockable.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

17

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Openings in walls, ceiling or floor - if required - must be complete.


Room lighting and wall outlets must have been installed.
Heating or air-conditioning systems should be ready for operation.
Walls and ceilings should have been painted. The room must be clean.
A minimum floor space of 1,70 m x 1,50 m must be provided
(if later extension is not foreseen).
Cable runways should be installed first.
All installation works of 3 phase 230 V AC power supply, including the circuit breakers in the AC-distribution panel (mechanically coupled), must be finished.

To prevent subsequent accumulation of dust and dirt, the parts and equipment units to
be installed should be unpacked outside the room (if possible).
After that it is advantageous to install the BTS, after all other installation works to create
the required infrastructure (power supply, antenna cabling, PCM line...) are complete.

2.3

Site Configuration
Operation of the BS-240 / 240XL / 240 II / 240XL II requires additional equipment on site:
microwave outdoor unit *

TX/RX antennas

external alarms**

PCM24/30 2 Mbit/s
3 x 230V/50Hz AC
(or -48 V DC)

AC-counter/
main breakers
in power distribution box

ground connection
*dependent on type of network integration
**optional

Fig. 2.2

Site configuration

2.4

Construction Overview of the BS-Types


The Base Station equipment of the BS-240 / 240 II is housed in racks with the dimensions of 1600 mm x 600 mm x 450 mm (H x W x D). The Base rack and each optional
Extension rack can be equipped with up to 8 Carrier Units.
The Base rack and the Extension rack of the BS-240XL / 240XL II can be equipped with
up to 12 Carrier Units. The dimensions of a BS-240XL / 240 XL II rack are
2050 mm x 600 mm x 450 mm (H x W x D).

18

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

For a full-featured Base Station, the maximum number of TRX is limited to 24 with CUs
and 48 with the use of FCUs.
The necessary space for installation is shown in Fig. 2.20. Because of the flexible configuration, several cable kits will be used for cable connections between the racks.
The first rack of Base Station is called Base rack and contains the following modules:
Generic Modules:
Core Basis (COBA): Essential components are the base core controller (BCC), the
advanced clock generation (ACLK), the carrier unit interfaces (CC-Link), the PCM30/24
Abis interfaces, the internal system alarm interface, the LMT interface and an interface
to one satellite (COSA) to expand the COBA.
The priority tasks of the module are the local controlling of the BTSE, the generating of
system clocks, providing all interfaces, routing data to the CU and handling and providing O&M messages.
Core Satellite (COSA): The task of the COSA is to expand the number of Abis interfaces and CC-links of the core. The essential components are the framing and line interface
(FALC) that provides the PCM30/24 port, the serial interface controller (SELIC) providing the CU-interface and the BUS-interface to the COBA. The COSA will be controlled
via a satellite interface by the COBA. To apply the feature cross connect, a COSA has
to be installed always into the base rack.
Alarm Collection Terminal (ACT): Collect all alarms for those units having no access
to the CAN-Bus and pass them via CAN-Bus interface to COBA.
Overvoltage Protection and Tracer (OVPT): Protects the PMC30 ports of core boards
from overvoltage and provides the monitoring interfaces for connected Abis-lines.
Abis Connection Module (ABISCON): Provides the interface between the base rack
and the peripheral Abis-cables. The ABISCON carries monitoring interfaces for connected Abis-lines and serves as interface for external synchronization clock.
Carrier related Modules:
Carrier Unit (CU): Consists of a receiving and transmitting part with synthesizer and
power amplifier, a signal processing unit as well as a power supply unit.
EDGE Carrier Unit (ECU): CU with supporting EDGE functionality in the up- and down
link.
Flex Carrier Unit (FCU): The FlexCU is a two-carrier unit and based on the ECU. The
FCU allows the expansion of the number of TRX per BTSE up to max. 48.
Antenna Combining Modules:
Duplexer Amplifier Multicoupler (DUAMCO): The DUAMCO consists of two identical
modules. Each module contains a duplex filter, that combines the TX and RX path together, to be fed a common antenna. If more than 2 carriers have to be combined to a
antenna system (with DUAMCO 2:2), a DUAMCO 4:2 or DUAMCO 8:2 has to be used.
Flexible Duplexer and Multicoupler (FDUAMCO): For each frequency band one type
of the FDUAMCO unit is available, that can be configurated with jumper cables for the
One-to-One mode (=DUAMCO 2.2) or Two-to-One mode (=DUAMCO 4:2). To provide
a DUAMCO 8:2 functionality, a COAMCO8 is required in addition to the
FDUAMCO.
Co-Duplexer and Multicoupler Extension (COAMCO8): The COAMCO8 is used with a
FDUAMCO together to provide a 8:2 configuration.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

19

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Filter Combiner (FICOM): One base module of the FICOM is needed per cell and is
able to combine the TX path of two carriers to one antenna. The base module can be
expanded with up to 3 expansion modules if more than 2 carriers should be combined
to one antenna. The expansion modules is able to combine 2 carriers in addition. In
maximum 8 carrier, that belongs to the same cell can be combined to one antenna.
DI-Amplifier Multicoupler (DIAMCO): The DIAMCO consists of two independend modules. Every module contains an RX-filter, a low noise amplifier (LNA), an attenuator, a
second LNA and a power splitter. The DIAMCO splits the RX antenna signal and can
drive up to 8 receiver inputs. Via the antenna feeder cable the DC power for the tower
mounted amplifier will be delivered by the DIAMCO.
High Power Duplexer (HPDU): The main task of the HPDU is to combine the TX- and
the RX-path to one antenna, in order to minimize the number of antennas if the FICOM
module is used.
For the Base Rack to function a Service Rack can be installed close to the Base Rack.
If only one Service Rack is located on site, it contains all infrastructure equipment:
AC/DC Converter (ACDC): Converts the AC mains voltage into the -48 Vdc supply voltage.
Link Equipment (LE): Can be NTPM, if terrestrial line is used for the connection to BSC
or microwave units.
Backup Batteries: Guarantees continuous operation for a certain time in case of mains
breakdown or AC/DC converter failure.

2.4.1

NOTE
All empty slots in a partially equipped subrack must be closed with cover plates so that
the air flow inside the rack will not be affected.
Cover plates are not necessary for link equipment and empty battery trays.

Rack Configuration of different BS-Variants


The following rack types exist:
Base rack: Contains the core modules, up to 8 carrier units (BS-240 / 240U II) or up
to 12 carrier units (BS240XL / 240XL II) and antenna combiners.
Extension rack: Contains up to 8 carrier units (BS-240 / 240 II) or up to 12 carrier
units (BS240XL / 240XL II) and antenna combiners.
Service1 rack (BS-240 / 240XL): Contains AC/DC converters, backup batteries and
link equipment in flexible configuration.
Service1A rack (BS-240 II / 240XL II): Contains up to 6 AC/DC converters, an
AC/DC distribution panel with Alarm Collection Terminal, backup batteries and link
equipment in flexible configuration.
Service2 rack (BS-240 / 240XL): Contains backup batteries and link equipment in
flexible configuration.
Service2 rack (BS-240 II / 240XL II): Contains a DC-LE Breaker Panel with Alarm
Collection Terminal, backup batteries and link equipment in flexible configuration.
The minimum configuration for a BS-240 / 240 II with a maximum of 8 carrier units
requires a Base rack and a Service1 / Service1A rack (optional, not needed in the case
of -48 Vdc supply from external power supply equipment).
The serving of a site with the maximum number of carrier units (24) requires the Base
rack, 2 Extension racks and a Service1 / Service1A rack.

20

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

For extension of link equipment or battery backup, additional Service2 racks can be added.
The BS-240 / 240 II site can consists of up to a maximum of 8 racks (Base rack, 2 Extension racks, Service1/Service1A rack, maximum 4 Service2 racks).
The minimum configuration for a BS-240XL / 240XL II with maximum 12 carrier units
requires a Base rack and a Service1 / Service1A rack (optional, not needed in the case
of -48 Vdc supply from external power supply equipment).
The serving of a site with the max. number of carrier units (24) requires the Extension
rack. For extension of link equipment or battery backup time, additional Service2 racks
can be added.
The number of Service racks depends on the number of installed carriers on site, the
volume of required link equipment and the expected battery backup time.
The BS-240XL / 240XL II site can consists of a maximum of 7 racks (Base rack, Extension rack, Service1 rack / Service1A rack, maximum 4 Service2 racks).

2.4.1.1

Rack Configurations BS-240


Fig. 2.3 shows the an example of rack types, that are needed for a BS-240 site with up
to 16 carriers.

SIEMENS

SIEMENS

SIEMENS
LMT

DC-PANEL

AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/


DC DC DC DC DC DC DC
CTRL 00 01 02 03 04 05

DC-PANEL

DC-PANEL

ACT-C

ACT-C

ETHERNET

ACT-C

ACOM ACOM ACOM ACOM


#1
#0
#3
#2

ACOM ACOM ACOM ACOM


#1
#0
#3
#2

CU CU
#0 #1

Service1 Rack

Fig. 2.3

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

CU
#7

CU CU
#2 #3

CU
#4

CU
#5

CU CU
#0 #1

Base Rack

MUCO #0

CU
#6

MUCO #1

MUCO #0

CU CU
#2 #3

COBA 0
COSA 0
COBA 1
COSA 1

LE 0
LE 1
LE 2
LE 3
LE 4
LE 5

MUCO #1

AC + DC Distribution

CU
#6

CU
#7

CU
#4

CU
#5

Extension Rack

Rack types of the BS-240

21

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

SIEMENS

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

SIEMENS

SIEMENS

SIEMENS

SIEMENS

DC-PANEL
ACT-C

DC-PANEL
ACT-C

DC-PANEL
ACT-C

DC-PANEL
ACT-C

AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/


DC DC DC DC DC DC DC

AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/


DC DC DC DC DC DC DC

AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/


DC DC DC DC DC DC DC

AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/


DC DC DC DC DC DC DC
CTRL 00 01 02 03 04 05

CTRL

00 01 02 03 04 05

AC + DC Distribution

CTRL

00 01 02 03 04 05

AC + DC Distribution

LE 0
LE 1
LE 2
LE 3
LE 4
LE 5

CTRL

00 01 02 03 04 05

AC + DC Distribution

AC + DC Distribution

AC/AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/AC/


DC DC DC DC DC DC DC

AC/AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/AC/


DC DC DC DC DC DC DC

CTRL 10

CTRL 10

11 12 13 14 15

AC + DC Distribution

DC-PANEL
ACT-C

AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/AC/


DC DC DC DC DC DC DC
00 01 02 03 04 05

CTRL

AC + DC Distribution

LE 0
LE 1
LE 2
LE 3
LE 4
LE 5
LE 6
LE 7
LE 8
LE 9

11 12 13 14 15

AC + DC Distribution

LE 0
LE 1
LE 2
LE 3
LE 4
LE 5

Fig. 2.4

LE 10
LE 11

Service1 rack configurations of the BS-240

SIEMENS

SIEMENS

SIEMENS

SIEMENS
DC-PANEL
ACT-C

DC-PANEL
ACT-C

LE 0
LE 1
LE 2
LE 3
LE 4
LE 5

DC-PANEL
ACT-C

DC-PANEL
ACT-C

LE 0
LE 1
LE 2
LE 3
LE 4
LE 5
LE 6
LE 7
LE 8
LE 9
LE 10
LE 11

LE 0
LE 1
LE 2
LE 3
LE 4
LE 5

LE 0
LE 1
LE 2
LE 3
LE 4
LE 5
LE 6
LE 7
LE 8
LE 9
LE 10
LE 11

Fig. 2.5

22

Service2 rack configurations of the BS-240

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.4.1.2

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Rack Configurations of the BS-240 II


The site configuration of racks and the functionality of a BS-240 II is equal to the
BS-240. The rack layouts, are shown in the figure below (example of a 16 carrier site).

SIEMENS

SIEMENS

SIEMENS

SIEMENS

0V -48V

FAN#0

ACTC

FAN#1

FAN#0

BR01BR02BR03 BR04BR05 BR06

0V -48V

FAN#0

FAN#1

ACTC

ACTC
BR01BR02BR03 BR04BR05 BR06BR07BR08

LE Panel (S2)

FAN#1

ACOM ACOM ACOM ACOM


#1
#0
#3
#2

HU # 0 for LE
HU # 1 for LE
HU # 2 for LE
HU # 3 for LE
HU # 4 for LE
HU # 5 for LE

AD Panel

LE

180A

+-

0V -48V

FAN#0

FAN#1

ACOM ACOM ACOM ACOM


#1
#0
#3
#2

ACTC

BR 33
X29
-48V
B E1E2 B E1E2

- - -

+++

FAN#2

FAN#3

FAN#2

FAN#3

0V -48V

HU # 4 for LE
HU # 5 for LE

FAN#4

FAN#5

CU CU
#2 #3

FAN#4

MUCO #1

CU
#7

MUCO #0

CU
#6

CU
#6

CU
#7

FAN#5

CU CU
#0 #1

Service1A Rack

Service2 Rack

COBA 0
COSA 0
COBA 1
COSA 1

160A

160A

MUCO #0

CU CU
#2 #3

MUCO #1

160A

LE Panel (S1A)

HU # 0 for LE
HU # 1 for LE
HU # 2 for LE
HU # 3 for LE

CU
#4

Base Rack

CU
#5

CU CU
#0 #1

CU
#4

CU
#5

Extension Rack

Note: CU can be Carrier Unit (CU) or EDGE Carrier Unit (ECU)


Fig. 2.6

Types of BS-240 II racks

2.4.1.3

Rack Configurations for BS-240XL


The following types of rack exist:
Base rack (contains core modules, up to 12 carrier units and antenna combiners)
Extension rack (contains up to 12 carrier units and antenna combiners)
Service1 rack (contains AC/DC converters, backup batteries and link equipment in
flexible configuration)
Service2 rack (contains backup batteries and link equipment in flexible configuration)
Refer to Tab. 2.1, Tab. 2.2, Tab. 2.3 for a selection of rack configurations.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

23

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

SIEMENS

SIEMENS

SIEMENS

DC-PANEL
ACT-C

FAN #0
LE #0
LE #1
LE #2
LE #3
LE #4
LE #5
LE #6
LE #7
LE #8
LE #9
LE #10
LE #11

SIEMENS

DC-PANEL
ACT-C

FAN #1

AC/

DC AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/

DC DC DC DC DC DC
#00 #00 #01 #02 #03 #04 #05

CTRL

DC-PANEL
ACT-C

ETHERNET DC-PANEL
ACT-C
LMT

FAN #0

FAN #0

FAN #1

ACOM ACOM ACOM ACOM


#0
#3
#2
#1

FAN #1

ACOM ACOM ACOM ACOM


#0
#1
#2
#3

AC + DC DISTRIBUTION

FAN #2

FAN #3

FAN #2

FAN #2

FAN #3

FAN #3

CU
#5

CU

CU

CU

CU

#10

#11

#4

#5

CU
#9

CU

CU

#2

#3

CU
#7

CU

MUCO #3

#4

MUCO #2

CU

MUCO #3

DC AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/


DC DC DC DC DC DC
#01 #10 #11 #12 #13 #14 #15

CTRL

MUCO #2

AC/

CU

CU

#10

#11

AC + DC DISTRIBUTION

1/4
Battery

FAN #6
CU
#0

1/4
Battery

1/4
Battery

1/4
Battery

Service2 Rack

1/4
Battery

Service1 Rack

CU
#1

CU
#8

FAN #6

FAN #7
CU
#6

Base Rack

#0

CU

FAN #5
MUCO #1

1/4
Battery

MUCO #1

1/4
Battery

MUCO #0

1/4
Battery

CU
#3

COBA #0
COSA #0
COBA #1
COSA #1

CU
#2

FAN #4

FAN #5

MUCO #0

FAN #4

CU

CU

#8

#9

FAN #7
CU

CU

#6

#7

#1

Extension Rack

Note: CU can be Carrier Unit (CU) or EDGE Carrier Unit (ECU)


Fig. 2.7

frame no.

installed modules Base Rack

installed modules Extension rack

4 (top)

4 x DUAMCO 2:2 or
4 x DUAMCO 4:2 or
2 x DUAMCO 8:2 or
4 x FICOM modules
(Base/Expansion modules in
site specific configuration)

4 x DUAMCO 2:2 or
4 x DUAMCO 4:2 or
2 x DUAMCO 8:2 or
4 x FICOM modules
(Base/Expansion modules in
site specific configuration)

4 x CU or ECU
2 x DIAMCO

4 x CU or ECU
2 x DIAMCO

4 x CU or ECU
2 x DIAMCO

4 x CU or ECU
2 x DIAMCO

1 (down)

4 x CU or ECU
2 x COBA;
2 x COSA

4 x CU or ECU

Tab. 2.1

24

Types of BS-240XL racks

Frame equipping variants, BS-240XL Base and Extension Racks

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Service1 rack
frame
no.

type 1

type 2

type 3

type 4

type 5

4 (top)

F:AC/DC1/1
2

F:AC/DC1/1
2

F:AC/DC1/1
2

F:AC/DC1/1
2

F:AC/DC1/1
2

F:LE

F:LE

F:AC/DC2

F:AC/DC2

F:AC/DC2

(6 x LE)

F:BATTERY

F:LE

F:LE

F:BATTERY

F:BATTERY

(6 x LE)

F:BATTERY

F:BATTERY

1 (down) F:BATTERY
DC
Output
Power

up to 4000 W

Tab. 2.2

up to 8000 W

Equipping variants, BS-240XL Service1 Rack

Service2 rack
frame no.

type 1
(R:BS120)

type 2
(R:BS120)

4 (top)

F:LE

F:LE

(6 x LE)

F:BATTERY

F:BATTERY

F:BATTERY

1 (down)

F:BATTERY

F:BATTERY

Tab. 2.3

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Equipping variants, BS-240XL Service2 Rack

25

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.4.1.4

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Rack Configurations for BS-240XL II


The rack layouts of the BS-240XL II are shown in the figure below (example of a
24 carrier site).

SIEMENS

SIEMENS
0V -48V

SIEMENS

FAN#0

ACTC

SIEMENS

FAN#1
ACTC

ACTC

LE Panel (S2)

FAN#0

FAN#1

FAN#0

HU # 0 for LE

FAN#1

ACOM ACOM ACOM ACOM


#0
#3
#2
#1

HU # 1 for LE

FAN#0

FAN#1

ACOM ACOM ACOM ACOM


#0
#1
#2
#3

HU # 2 for LE
HU # 3 for LE

AD Panel

HU # 4 for LE
HU # 5 for LE
FAN#2

LE

180A

+-

ACTC

BR 33
X29
-48V
B E1E2 B E1E2

- - -

+++

FAN#3

FAN#2

FAN#3

FAN#2

FAN#3

0V -48V

HU # 3 for LE

160A

160A

FAN#4

CU

CU

#2

#3

Service1A Rack

CU
#1

CU

CU

CU

CU

CU

CU

#10

#11

#4

#5

#10

#11

FAN#5

CU
#8

FAN#6

CU
#0

Service2 Rack

CU
#5

ACOM #4

HU # 11 for LE

160A

HU # 1 for LE
HU # 2 for LE

160A

HU # 9 for LE
HU # 10 for LE

CU
#4

HU # 0 for LE

CU
#9

FAN#7

COBA #0
COSA #0
COBA #1
COSA #1

LE Panel (S1A)

HU # 7 for LE
HU # 8 for LE

ACOM #5

HU # 6 for LE

CU
#6

CU
#7

Base Rack

FAN#4

FAN#5

CU

CU

CU

CU

#2

#3

#8

#9

FAN#6

CU
#0

CU
#1

FAN#7

CU

CU

#6

#7

Extension Rack

Note: CU can be Carrier Unit (CU), EDGE Carrier Unit (ECU)


or Flex Carrier Unit (FlexCU)
Fig. 2.8

26

Types of BS-240XL II Racks

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.5
2.5.1

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Equipment Delivery
Preliminary Checks
A ShockwatchTM -label and a TIP (N) TELLTM-label are fixed at the rack surface in the
case of pallet transportation or at the crate for indication of fallover or strong shocks during the transport from factory to the site.
If the TIP (N) TELLTM-label arrow is blue, the package has been on the side or tipped
over in transit. If the ShockwatchTM -label is red, the package has been shocked during
transport.
Check that the crate and label are proper condition. In case of evident damage due to
transport, unpack the equipment in presence of an insurance company representative
and promptly claim any damage and inform the shipper for specifying the damage.
Check whether the package is actually addressed to the site and complete.

ShockwatchTM -label

TiltwatchTM-label

Fig. 2.9

2.5.2

ShockwatchTM-label and TiltwatchTM-label

Rack mounted on a Pallet


Unpack the rack according to the following instructions and in accordance with
Fig. 2.10.
Cut the two straps (1).
Cut the protection foil along the cardboard corner reinforcement (2) and remove it.
Remove the cardboard reinforcement on the top and from the corners of the rack.
Unscrew the four fixing claws from the feet of the rack.
Retain the claws for later floor fixing of the rack.
Shift the rack carefully from the transportation pallet. A second person is needed for
help and to prevent the fallover of the rack.

WARNING
Safety gloves and goggles must be worn when cutting the straps. Pay attention to the
tension of the straps. Use only plate shears.

WARNING
Do not burn the package, as the burning packaging material may give off toxic gases.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

27

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

The Service racks will be delivered without backup batteries (weight aspects).
Additional crates are used for transporting of the batteries.

2
1

2.5.3

Fig. 2.10

Rack mounted on the pallet

Fig. 2.11

Dismounting the rack from the pallet

Rack shipped in a Crate


The racks are shipped vertically in wooden crates (or horizontally in case of transportation by airplane).The crate dimensions for the BS-240 / 240 II are
1800 mm x 800 mm x 650 mm (HxWxD). Depending on the pre-installed modules inside the racks, the crate can weigh up to approx. 190 kg.
The crate dimensions for the BS-240XL / 240XL II are 2225 mm x 800 mm x 650 mm
(HxWxD).
The Service racks will be delivered without backup batteries (weight aspects).

28

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Additional crates are used for transporting of the batteries.


All crates have the following information printed on them for identification of delivery:
Customer order number
Serial number of rack or other supplied equipment
Destination
Gross and net weight
Overall dimensions (cm)
Delivery papers
For transportation of the crates from the unloading area into the construction room use
handling aids (for example: fork-lift truck, goods elevator), a second person is needed
for help.
During the unpacking steps, great care must be taken to ensure that the rack is not
scratched or damaged in any way. Unpack the rack according to the following figures.

unscrew

cut
Fig. 2.12

Removal of the straps, opening of the top cover

WARNING
Safety gloves and goggles must be worn when cutting the straps.
Pay attention to the tension of the straps. Use only plate shears.

Cut the three straps (see Fig. 2.12) and remove the 10 M4 screws on the top of the
crate (see Fig. 2.12).
Remove the crates top cover.
Take out the packing material protecting the rack (see Fig. 2.13).
Remove the protection to the head and to the base of the rack.
Open and remove the tubular PE-wrap protecting the rack (see Fig. 2.14).
Take the rack out of the crate with the aid of the straps around the rack.
Lift the rack in vertical position.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

29

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Fig. 2.13

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Removal of the packing material

cut

Fig. 2.14

Opening of the PE-wrap, lifting straps around the rack

Immediately after unpacking the rack, inspect it for damage and report the extent of any
damage to the transportation company.

2.5.4

WARNING
The burning of packing material should be avoided, because packaging may give off
toxic gases.

Unpacking of Modules and Batteries


Proceed the unpacking of modules as follows:
Open the carton with a suitable knife along the adhesive tape at the top.
Take the PVC foil bag that contain the module out of the carton.
Open the PVC protection bag carefully with the knife and take out the module.
Avoid the handling of the modules in high-static environmental. The packing material
should be preserved for possible re-packing in future.
The battery sets of the Service1/2 racks will be shipped in wooden crates, including a
plastic bag that contain cable sets, screws,washers and the connection plates.
Further the parts of the air vent system and the installation instruction.

30

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

cut

Fig. 2.15

2.5.5

Unpacking of the battery sets

Cut the tension belts with a plate shear.


Remove the top cover of the wooden crate.
Take the batteries out of the crate using the battery handles.

Rack Installation
Prior to the commencement of rack installation, consult the site documentation to locate
the installation point of the Base Station, the PCM24/30 network termination, AC mains
or power supply unit (if -48Vdc will be provided from external equipment) and the access
of the antenna cables into the construction room.
After that check the proper installation of the earthing bar and the necessary cable runways.
If the rack must be moved to the final installation position by crane and for later connection works, it is necessary to remove the top cover of the rack.
Proceed as follows:
Open the rack-door and remove both screws in the upper part of the front of rack.
(see Fig. 2.16).
Lift up the top cover and slide it back.
Disconnect the green/yellow ground wire from the pin inside the top cover.

WARNING
Before opening the rack-door take measures to prevent the rack from falling over!
Note the accident prevention regulations when working with a fork lift truck or crane!
Dont remove the crane eyes after the crane transport is finished to guarantee the later
EMI-closeness of the rack!
If the racks stand side by side, they must be screwed together to one common unit with
one nut and screw M8x20 (part of MK:EMCRV1 for rack variant I or MK:EMCR-2V1 for
rack variant II). For this purpose the top cover has to be removed as shown in the figure
Fig. 2.16.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

31

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

remove the screws

ground wire

Fig. 2.16

Removal of top cover for crane eye access

For BS-240 II/ BS-240XL II rack type proceed as follows:


Open the rack-door (see Fig. 2.17): Slide down the protection cover (1), push the
button behind the cover (2) and flap out the handle (3).
Turn the handle counterclockwise 90 (4).
Slide the top cover 20 mm in front direction and lift it up (see Fig. 2.18).
Disconnect the green/yellow ground wire from the pin inside the top cover.

3
4
2
1

Fig. 2.17

32

Opening of rack door

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

ground wire
Fig. 2.18

Removal of the top cover

65
60

BS-240 / 240XL
Fig. 2.19

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

BS-240 II / 240XL II

Guideline for crane transport

33

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

**)

**)
1900 mm

600 mm

*) distance
to wall

450 mm

2350 mm

minimum
room height

750 mm

BS-240XL

500 mm

BS-240

2200 mm

*) distance
to wall

**)

750 mm

450 mm

2025 mm

1600 mm

min. dimensions for 3-rack solution

1700 mm

450 mm

min. dimensions for double rack solution

Note:
*) Minimum clearance rear to wall for:
BS-240 without earthquake kit close to wall
BS-240 XL without earthquake mounting kit: 50 mm
BS-240 XL with earthquake kit Siemens serial no. S30861-K2131-X: 400 mm
BS-240 II / 240XL II: 50 mm (without earthquake kit)
BS-240 II / 240XL II with earthquake kit Siemens serial no. S30861-K4119-X: 150 mm
Minimum clearance by back-to-back assembly for:
BS-240 II / 240XL II: 100 mm (without earthquake kit)
BS-240XL: 100 mm (without earthquake kit)
**) the distance between two racks, side by side must not exceed 1mm
Fig. 2.20

Space necessary for installation of Base Station rack variants

34

WARNING
The total weight of rack must not exceed 360 kg (BS-240 / 240 II) or 425 kg (BS-240XL
/ 240XL II) respectively when being lifted.
For determination the weight refer to section Technical Data.
Under no circumstances must the sets of batteries be inserted into the Service Racks
during transportation on site. The doors must be kept closed during transportation.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

NOTE
To prevent the racks from tipping over (product safety) they must be fixed either to a wall
(exepted in earthquake zones) or the floor.
The minimum distance from the rear of the rack to the wall must be considered. It is recommended to prepare the fixings before moving the rack to its final position.
The four fastening claws, delivered with the rack, can be used for floor fixing of the racks.

Fig. 2.21

Adjusting and fixing of the rack feet

Proceed as described in the list below:


Check the correct vertical rack position, using the spirit level. If the position is incorrect, equalize the differences in the floor height by adjusting the rack feet (see
Fig. 2.21).
Loosen the lock nut (1) and adjust the rack feet (2) for proper floor contact by using
the adjuster feet wrench.
Push a claw (3) on each of the 4 rack feet and mark the drilling point on the floor.
Remove the claws and drill the 4 holes and insert the 4 wall plugs (e.g. Fischer
S8GK) into the holes.
Push the claws on the rack feet and fix them.
Alternatively the rack can be fastened to the wall. The rack has two right angle brackets
on its top rear for mounting to wall (Fig. 2.22, right side). Depending from the rack type,
the necessary minimum distance must be considered from rear of the rack to the wall
(see Fig. 2.20). An right dimensioned additional distance piece can be helpful therefor.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

35

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Fig. 2.22

2.5.5.1

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Floor and wall mounting of the racks

WARNING
In earthquake zones, the fastening to wall is prohibited. Use the earthquake mounting
kit for securing to the floor.

Setup of Earthquake Mounting Kit for BS-240


For setup the earthquake mounting kit (S30861-K2086-X) proceed in steps as follows:
Mark the positions of the drilling holes in accordance with Fig. 2.24.
Drill the holes with 18 mm in diameter and a depth of 90 mm. Dont pre-drill the
holes!
Produce an undercut of the drilling holes: drill the hole to stop and swivel the jack
hammer 3-5 times keeping stop to concrete.
Clean out the drilling holes by a vacuum.
Put steel plug (e.g. Fischer FZA 18x80 M10 I) into the inserting tool (e.g. Fischer
FZE 18) and hammer into each hole until the sleeve is flush with surface.
Fit bolts M10 (1) with washer (2) through both holes of claw (3) and distance plate
(4). Drive the bolts into the steel plugs as fast as possible. Fix in this way all claws
for the rear side rack feeds first.
Shift the racks to the correct position, so that each of the rear adjuster feet is placed
in the cutout of a claw.
Push a claw on each of the front side feeds and fix them with bolts and washers. The
distance plates are not needed for the front side row.

36

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

1
2

3
2 x for rearside of rack

0
50

485
535

32,5

1085
1135

Earthquake mounting kit

600
650

Fig. 2.23

2x for frontside of rack

0
rear

Service1 Rack

Base Rack

front

Fig. 2.24

2.5.5.2

463

Drilling sketch for earthquake mounting kit (2 racks)

Setup of Earthquake Mounting Kit for BS-240XL


For setup the earthquake mounting kit (S30861-K2131-X) proceed in steps as follows:
Mark the positions of the drilling holes in accordance with Fig. 2.25.
Drill the holes with 22 mm in diameter and a depth of 90 mm. Dont pre-drill the
holes!
Produce an undercut of the drilling holes: drill the hole to stop and swivel the jack
hammer 3-5 times keeping stop to concrete.
Clean out the drilling holes by a vacuum.
Put steel plug (e.g. Fischer FZA 22x100 M12I) into the inserting tool (e.g. Fischer
FZE 22) and hammer into each hole until the sleeve is flush with surface.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

37

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

rack length 600 mm

57,5 mm

423 mm

423 mm

335 mm

rack depth 450 mm

600 mm

diameter 22 mm

88,5 mm
Fig. 2.25

Drilling sketch for earthquake mounting kit (2 racks)

Check the completeness of the mounting kit according to the following figure and remove the rear panel of the rack.
1

4
2

4
2
5

4
4

6
3

4
4
Fig. 2.26

38

Parts of the earthquake mounting kit for the BS-240XL

Remount the adjuster feet, setup the 4 metal angles (1) and fix them with Allan screw
(6) as shown in Fig. 2.27.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

1
6
1

Fig. 2.27

Mounting of Pos. 1

Click spring nuts in the extrusions.


Insert both stiffening parts (2).
Move the stiffening parts to rear and lateral side to stop.
extrusion

Fig. 2.28

Mounting of stiffening parts (1)

Slide in the filler plates (3).


Fix each stiffening part with 12 Allan screws M6 (4).
3

Fig. 2.29

Mounting of stiffening parts (2)

Fasten the rack to the steel plugs in the floor with 4 bolts M12 (5).

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

39

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.5.6

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Remove the 4 Allan screws (6). It is absolute necessary, that the edge pieces can
work free of strain in the case of earthquake.
Mount again the rear panel.

NOTE
The use of the earthquake mounting kit for BS-240XL requires a minimum clearance to
the wall of 400 mm.

NOTE
For mounting the earthquake mounting kit in a service rack, first the battery tray has to
be remounted.applying to your system.

WARNING
Take measures to prevent the rack falling over during the removal of the adjuster feet
and mounting of the metal angles. A second person is needed for help! The rack door
stay must be locked in the open position using the door stay provided, whilst work is being performed inside the rack.

Setup of Earthquake Mounting Kit for BS-240 II / 240XL II


In areas with the possibility of earthquake use the mounting kit for Earthquake Zone 4
Rack (MK:EQ4RV2, S30861-K4119-X). The additional brackets improve the robustness
of the rack against earthquake shocks.
The mounting kit consists of the mechanical parts as shown in the figure below.

Fig. 2.30

Parts of the earthquake kit S3086-K4119-X

Fix the rack to the floor in accordance with Fig. 2.33 in steps as follows:
Mark the positions of the drilling holes onto the floor.
Drill holes at the marked points with 18 mm in diameter and a depth of 98 mm. Dont
pre-drill the holes!
Produce an undercut of the drilling holes: drill the hole to stop and swivel the jack
hammer 3-5 times keeping stop to concrete.

40

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Clean out the drilling holes with a vacuum cleaner.


Put dowels (3) (e.g. HILTI - M12*73 / 20) into the drilling holes and hammer them
until the sleeve is flush with surface (use an inserting tool, if available).
Place the double claw (1) at its mounting position and fix it with the provided bolts at
the rear dowels (see Fig. 2.31).
Tighten the bolts to a torque of 60 Nm.
Shift the rack to the appropriate position, so that each of the rear rack feet is placed
in a cut-out of the double claw (Fig. 2.31).
Open the rack door.
Insert a claw (2) on each of the front feet and affix them with the M12 bolts to the
dowels in front of the rack (see Fig. 2.32).
Tighten the connection to a torque of 60 Nm.

Fig. 2.31

Double claw for the rear feet in mounted position

Fig. 2.32

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Claws for the front feet before mounting

41

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

465

450

600

142.5

wall

485
57.5
(sketch without scale, all measures in mm)

front side
Fig. 2.33

42

Drilling sketch for the earthquake mounting kit

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.5.7

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Back-to-back Assembly
Back-to-back assembly means all configurations that are not lined up in a connected
row, but with distance between the sidewalls of racks. These configuration are according to customer requirements.
The open cable channel for inter-rack cabling from one rack to the other one has to be
closed with an EMI shielded mechanical EMI-kit. In this conduit, the DC-cables, battery
cables and the temp.resistor cables will be routed from one rack to the other.
An U-profile bar above the conduit will be used for routing of the Selic-bus-cables and
CAN-bus-cable. The mechanical equipment and cables necessary for connecting the
racks are part of corresponding mounting kits.

NOTE
Other configurations with up to 5 m distance are possible and have to be defined for
specific project. In this case additional mechanical support and sleeve equipment as
well as extended cables, described in the following tables, are necessary.
2500 mm

*) Minimum clearance for BS-240 II / 240 XL II / 240 XL

1600 mm

*)100 mm

750 mm

conduit
S30861-S2146-S

Fig. 2.34

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Back-to-back configuration

43

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

max. 5 m

450 mm

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

750 mm

S30861-S2146-S
conduit
profile bar
(Z- clearance of rear to wall, depend on rack type)

Fig. 2.35

Side-by-side configuration

S30861-S2146-S
Extension1

profile bar
2400 mm + 2 x Z

Base

1500 mm

Service1

conduit

Extension2

(Z - clearance of rear to wall,


depend on rack type)

Fig. 2.36

44

Back-to-back configuration with Extension1 and Extension2

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Base

S30861-S2147-S
conduit
profile bar

Extension1

Service2

Fig. 2.37

2400 mm + 2 x Z

Service1

(Z- clearance of rear to wall, depend on rack type)

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

1500 mm

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Back-to-back configuration with Service1 and Service2

Detailed information about the wall distances (Z) of the different Rack types is described
in the chapter 2.5.5 / Fig. 2.20.
Additional to the standard configurations of back-to-back assembly as shown in the figures of this section other configuration with distances up to 5 metres are possible.
In this case required components and extended cables have to be defined in accordance to customers requirements depending on length of flexible conduit.
The following tables informs about the mechanical components and typical cables for
extension.Measure X is the length of the flexible conduit and means also the additional
cable length.
The relation between cables with Siemens code no. and cable no. is given in Tab. 2.9.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

45

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Service
2/3

Service
2/2

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

distance
X

Service
2/1

Service
1

S2/1-S2/2

Base

Extension
1

Extension
2

S1-S2/2

S1-S2/3

E2-S2/2

DC cable

Rack

(33)+X

CAN-Bus cable

Rack

Battery cable

Rack

(110/3,
111/3)+X

(110/4,
111/4)+X

Temp.resitor
cable

Rack

1)
(112/3)

1)
(112/4)

conduit

Rack

(249)+X

2)

1) max. distance of AC/DC frame 2,5 m otherwise use up to 5 m cable 112/4


2) type of flexible conduit see Tab.Types of flexible conduit
Tab. 2.4

Gap between Service2/1 and Service2/2 rack

Service
2/3

Service
2/2

Service
2/1

DC cable

Rack

CAN-Bus cable

Rack

Selic cable

Rack

conduit

Rack

Service
1

Base

Extension
1

distance
X

Extension
2

S2/2-E2

S2/1-E2

S1-E2

B-E2

E1-E2

1)
(36)+X
(249)+X

(248)+X
1)
(277,
278)+X
2)

1) replace fix installed cable by extended cable (+X)


2) type of flexible conduit see Tab. Types of flexible conduit
Tab. 2.5

46

Gap between Extension1and Extension2 rack

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Service
2/2

Service
2/1

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Service
1

Base

distance
X

Extension
1

Extension
2

S2/2-E1

S2/2-E2

S2/1-E1

S2/1-E2

S1-E1

S1-E2

1)
(35)+X

B-E1

B-E2

1)
(277,278
)+X

DC cable

Rack

CAN-Bus cable

Rack

Battery cable

Rack

1)
(277,278
)+X

conduit

Rack

2)

(249)+X

(247)+X

(248)+X

1)
(36)+X

(246)+X

1) Replace fix installed cables by extended cables (+X)


2) type of flexible conduit see Tab. Types of flexible conduit
Tab. 2.6

Gap between Base and Extension1 rack

Service
2/3

Service
2/2

Service
2/1

distance
X

Service
1

Base

Extension
1

Extension
2

S2/2-E2

S2/1-E1

S2/1-E2

S1-S2/1

S1-S2/2

S1-S2/3

DC cable

Rack

3)
(33)+X

CAN-Bus cable

Rack

Battery cable

Rack

(110/2+
111/2)+X

(110/3+
111/3)+X

(110/4+
111/4)+X

Temp.resistor cable

Rack

1)
(112/2)

2)
(112/3)

2)
(112/3)

conduit

Rack

4)

(249)+X

(247)+X

(248)+X

1) max. distance from AC/DC frame to battery 2,5 m, otherwise use cable 112/3
2) max. distance from AC/DC frame to battery 5,5 m, otherwise a special must be defined
3) Replace fix installed cables by extended cables (+X)
4) type of flexible conduit see Tab. Types of flexible conduit
Tab. 2.7

Gap between Service2/1 and Service1 rack

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

47

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Service
2/3

Service
2/2

Service
2/1

DC cable

Rack

CAN-Bus cable

Rack

conduit

Rack

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Service
1

distance
X

Base

Extension
1

Extension
2

S2/2-E1

S2/2-E2

S2/1-E1

S2/1-E2

S1-B

(249)+X

(247)+X

(248)+X

S1-E1

1)
(34)+X

1)
(35)+X

(245)+X

(246)+X

S1-E2
1)
(36)+X

2)

1) Replace fix installed cables by extended cables (+X)


2) type of flexible conduit see Tab. Types of flexible conduit
Tab. 2.8

Gap between Service1 and Base


The following cables with Siemens code no. are typical cables for interrack-cabling without extension.
cable code no.

Siemens code no.

110/2, 111/2

S30864-X211-A47

110/3, 111/3

S30864-X211-A48

110/4, 111/4

S30864-X211-A49

112/2

S30864-X211-A44

112/3

S30864-X211-A45

33

Component of S30864-X211-A29

34

Component of S30864-X211-A29

35

Component of S30864-X211-A29

36

Component of S30864-X211-A29

245

S30864-X210-A11

246

S30864-X210-A12

247

S30864-X210-A13

248

S30864-X210-A14

249

S30864-X210-A15

277

S30864-X210-A2

278

S30864-X210-A2

Tab. 2.9

Interrack-cables without extension

The cables 33-36 are fix installed in the Service1 rack and have to be replaced by extended according to back-to-back configuration. The installation requires the temporary
removal of the plate, located at the top of EMI-panel.

48

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

flexible conduit

Siemens code no.

type 1 (distance 0,625 m - 2,40 m) C50324-Z200-C22


type 2 (distance 1,25 m - 5,00 m)
Tab. 2.10

C50324-Z200-C21

Types of flexible conduit

NOTE
Grounding connections to extended racks are required by separate connections from
external grounding bar!

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

49

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.6
2.6.1

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

External Cabling Activities


Overview
This chapter provides the information required for installing the external cables between
the Base Station and the infrastructure equipment on site.
The rack cannot function without the following cable connections:
In case of an AC power supply: AC mains terminal block 5 pole - power distribution
panel of 230 Vac, 3-phase supply
By using of an DC power supply: DC mains terminal block 2 pole - power distribution
panel of -48Vdc
Ground bolts -> ground bar
Abis interface -> NTPM (in case of transmission via terrestrial lines)
Abis interface -> Microwave indoor units (if W equipment is used o
f r transmission)
Microwave indoor units -> Microwave antennas
Transmit / receive antenna connectors - antenna system
Ground strip of antenna cable shields - ground bar
optional:
Serial interface - signalling link terminal
Alarm collection terminal - external alarm sensors
All interfaces excepted the antenna connectors are located at the EMI panel below the
top rack cover.
For cable installation the top cover has to be removed. For lift-up remove the bolts in the
top extrusions.
ground bolts

Ext.1 CU 4...7
OVPT0

OVPT1

Ext.1 CU 0...3
Ext.2 CU 4...7

CAN OUT

-48 V

CAN TEST Serial IF

Ext.2 CU 0...4

LPA

MSU

PE-Plate

Fig. 2.38

50

ACTM

Interfaces on the top of the BS-240 Base Rack

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

ground bolts

CU 4...7
CU 0...3

CAN OUT CAN IN


CAN TEST

LPA

MSU

PE-Plate

Fig. 2.39

Interfaces on the top of the BS-240 Extension Rack

ground bolts

CAN OUT CAN IN


CAN TEST

LPA

MSU

PE-Plate

Fig. 2.40

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Interfaces on the top of the BS-240/240XL Service1Rack

51

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

ground bolts

CAN OUT CAN IN


CAN TEST

LPA

PE-Plate

Fig. 2.41

Interfaces on the top of the BS-240/240XL Service2 Rack

ground bolts

Ext.1 CU 8...11
OVPT0

OVPT1

CAN OUT

-48 V

Ext.1 CU 4...7
Ext.1 CU 0...3

CAN TEST Serial IF


LPA

MSU

PE-Plate

Fig. 2.42

52

ACTM

Interfaces on the top of the BS-240XL Base Rack

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

ground bolts

CU 8...11
CU 4...7
CU 0...3

CAN OUT CAN IN


CAN TEST

LPA

MSU

PE-Plate

Fig. 2.43

Interfaces on the top of the BS-240XL Extension Rack

ground bolts

OVPT0

CAN IN

OVPT1

-48 V

CAN OUT Serial IF


CAN TEST LPA
MSU
PE-bolts

ACTM
Ext.1 CU 4...7
Ext.1 CU 0...3
Ext.2 CU 4...7

Ext.2 CU 0...3

Fig. 2.44

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Interfaces on the top of the BS-240 II Base Rack

53

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

ground bolts

CAN IN
CAN OUT
CAN TEST LPA

MSU
PE-bolts

CU 4...7
CU 0...3

Fig. 2.45

Interfaces on the top of the BS-240 II Extension Rack

ground bolts

CAN IN
CAN OUT
CAN TEST LPA

PE-bolts
MSU

Fig. 2.46

54

Interfaces on the EMI-Panel of the BS-240 II/240XL II Service1 Rack

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

ground bolts

CAN IN
CAN OUT
CAN TEST LPA

PE-bolts

Fig. 2.47

Interfaces on the top of the BS-240 II /240XL II Service2 Rack

ground bolts

OVPT0

CAN IN

OVPT1

-48 V

CAN OUT Serial IF


CAN TEST LPA
MSU
PE-bolts

ACTM

Ext.1 CU 8...11
Ext.1 CU 4...7

Ext.1 CU 0...3

Fig. 2.48

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Interfaces on the top of the BS-240XL II Base Rack

55

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

ground bolts

CAN IN

-48 V

CAN OUT
CAN TEST LPA
MSU
PE-bolts

CU 8...11
CU 4...7

CU 0...3

Fig. 2.49

Interfaces on the top of the BS-240XL II Extension Rack

Some additional hints for the installation of external cabling:


The first cable that has to be installed is the ground cable between the main ground
bolt on top of the rack and the nearest ground bar on site.
The second installation step is to connect the ground bolts of the different racks in
series.
After that all other cables e.g. AC mains, RF cabling or alarm wires can be installed.
The screen of the RF jumpers has to be grounded before entering the BTSE via the
cable feeding module, see Fig. 2.88.
If cables are fed through coaxial cable access located at the top of the rack at the
front, the screen has to be grounded like all other coaxial cables.
The following figure shows the location of the external interfaces of the BS-240/240XL
(example of BS-240 with Service1-, Base- and Extension rack).

56

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

serial interface cable


external alarms / commands
Abis lines (OVPT PCM0, PCM1)
antenna cables
-48 Vdc*

3 x 230 Vac **
ground cable
microwave
SIEMENS

SIEMENS
LMT
ETHERNET

SIEMENS
LMT

DC-PANEL
ACT-C

AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/ AC/


DC DC DC DC DC DC DC
CTRL
#0 #0 #1 #2 #3 #4 #5

LMT

DC-PANEL
ACT-C

ETHERNET

ACOM ACOM ACOM ACOM


#1
#0
#3
#2

ETHERNET

DC-PANEL
ACT-C

ACOM ACOM ACOM ACOM


#1
#0
#3
#2

CU CU
#0 #1

Service1 rack

CU
#7

CU
#4

CU
#5

Base rack

CU CU
#2 #3

CU CU
#0 #1

MUCO #1

CU
#6

MUCO #0

MUCO #1

CU CU
#2 #3

COBA 0
COSA 0
COBA 1
COSA 1

LE 0
LE 1
LE 2
LE 3
LE 4
LE 5

MUCO #0

AC + DC Distribution

CU
#6

CU
#7

CU
#4

CU
#5

Extension rack

*) only used if an external DC-power supply is available


**) if an external 3 x 230 V ac power supply source will be used

Fig. 2.50

Locations of the connectors for external cables

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

57

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.6.2

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Ground and AC- Power Supply Connections


The racks have to be connected to the site specific ground system before starting the
connection of AC mains cable.
An external ground wire (16 mm2, copper conductor) has to be connected on the upper
left side grounding bolt of the rack which must be attached to the ground bar on site. All
adjoining racks will be grounded using a prefabricated wire bridge and is connected to
top left and right corners of each rack respectively.
If on site a main ground wire (50 mm2, copper conductor) is installed, it is possible to
connect each rack on the shortest way to the main ground using 16 mm2 copper wires.
Connect the racks to the ground system as follows:
Use the nearest ground bar on site.
Measure the distances between the connection points of the ground system and the
ground bolt of the rack.
Cut the cables to the required length.
Remove the cable covering at the end to connect to the ground bolt (length approx.
15 mm) and mount the cable lug M8.
Connect the prepared cable end to the ground bolt.
Firmly tighten the nut.

alternative solution for rack grounding

50 mm2 main ground wire


16 mm 2ground wires
ground wire bridges

H07-RN F 5 G41)
AC distribution
AC counter
3 x 25 A main breakers2)
3 x 32 A main breakers3)
3 x 230 Vac mains

connection to ground

1) cross section needed depend on the cable length between external breaker and MSU
2) BS-241, BS-240, BS-240XL
3) BS-241 II, BS-240 II, BS-240XL II
Fig. 2.51

Ground and AC mains connections (example)

WARNING
Note, that the connection by screws at the top of racks standing side by side is a mechanical connection only. These connection is not a ground connection!
The figure above shows the recommended cabling for the power supply and ground
connections. The recommended cable types guarantees the proper function of the base
stations, equipped with up to 24 carriers.

58

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

An easily accessible disconnect device is incorporated into the AC mains supply wiring.
To isolate the mains supply, a circuit breaker has to be fitted in each phase inside the
AC distribution box close to the base station (see Fig. 2.51). The disconnect devices
shall simultaneously interrupt all phase conductors.
A 5-pole terminal block of the MSU, located in the top of Service1 / Service1A rack, is
the connection point for the AC mains cable.
The base station will be powered by 3 x 230 V, 50 Hz, 20 A per phase.
PE L3 L2 L1 N

Fig. 2.52

Wiring example of the 230 Vac terminal block (BS-240 Service1 Rack)

This warning must appear in the original German text:


Vor Anschlu des 3 x 230 V Einspeisungskabels ist sicherzustellen, da das Kabel
spannungsfrei ist. Die Hauptsicherungen sind zu unterbrechen. Es sind geeignete
Manahmen gegen unbefugtes Einschalten der Netzspannung zu treffen.
An imprint, located on the front panel of the AC frame gives instruction how to deenergize the base station:
To deenergize entire unit:
1. Switch OFF BATT 0 + BATT 1(BR14 + BR15) to deenergise DC circuit
2. Switch OFF breakers (BR11 + BR12 + BR13) to deenergise AC circuit
To connect the BS240/240XL with the AC mains connection point perform the following
steps:
Remove the bolts in the top extrusions to loosen the roof.
Lift-up the roof sections carefully, to avoid damages of the paint coat.
Refer to the site documentation for information about type and location of the AC distribution.
Measure the distance between terminal block of the MSU and AC distribution.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

59

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.6.3

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Cut the cable to the required length.


Make sure that the protection earth wire (PE) is approx. 2 cm longer as the phase
conductors and the N-wire.
Remove the insulation of the cable and cut back the wire insulation at the end, that
is to be connected to the terminal block.
Fix the cable at the strain relief with cable ties.
Insert the wires into the terminals. Use a screwdriver for opening the terminal
springs. Check that all wires are in fixed position.

Ground and DC- Power Supply Connections


For connecting the base station with an external -48 Vdc power supply unit a
Service1/Sevice1A Rack is not needed.
Depending on the site-specific power supply configuration, the racks have to be connected directly with the power supply unit or via a power distribution panel.
The following figure shows the power supply configuration for the BTS, including a power distribution panel.
The power supply unit, as shown in Fig. 2.53, is intended to be supplied by a -48 Vdc
centralized battery source. The charging rectifiers must be internally insulated from the
AC mains by insulating transformers.
The positive pole of the backup batteries has to be connected to ground.
main ground wire 50 mm2

alternative solution for rack grounding


DC main wires
2
2 x H 07 V-R 16 mm *)
2
2 x H 07 V-R 35 mm **)***)

ground wire
2
H 07 V-R 16 mm
(yellow/green)

main breaker

ground
wires

UE -48 V DC +
2

H 07 V-R 35 mm
power supply
unit

optional
power distribution
panel
fuse per rack:
50 A *)
80 A **)
100 A ***)

DC supply +0 V pole
connected to ground
backup
batteries

Fig. 2.53

60

battery +0 V pole
connected to ground

ground bar
2
*) BS-240 / Service2
50 mm
**) BS-240XL / BS-240 II
***) BS-240XL II

Ground- and power supply connections with -48V DC

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation of the DC wires is as follows:


Measure the distance between rack and the power supply unit or power distribution
panel.
Cut the wires to the required length.
Remove the cable insulation (length approx. 12 mm) at the ends to be connected to
the terminal block of the MSU (the location is shown in Fig. 2.54).
Insert the prepared ends into the terminal block.
Pay attention to the correct polarity of the connection from BTS to the DC output of
the power supply unit.

-48 V +0 V
Fig. 2.54

Terminal block for -48 V DC input of MSU (BS-240)

For installation of the ground connection proceed as described in section 2.6.2 of this
manual.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

61

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.6.4

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Abis-Interface - PCM Link Terminal


The Abis interfaces PCM0 and PCM1, located on the EMI panel, provides the communication links to the neighboring Base Stations or to the controlling BSC.
The Abis interfaces can be terminated with an ABISCON (without Overvoltage Protection for indoor applications) or with an optional Overvoltage Protections (OVPT) which
protects the boards inside the rack against overvoltage (residual voltage < 1 kV).
Two types of ABISCON/OVPT exist:
ABISCON/OVPT for 120 cables (balanced)
ABISCONCX/OVPTCOAX for 75 cables (coaxial)

NOTE
If the connection point for the Abis line (e.g., NTPM or microwave equipment) is outside
the building where the BTSE is installed, an OVPT module has to be installed always.
Depending on the different cable impedances it is recommended to use:
Screened cable containing 8/10 shielded twisted pairs 0,25 mm2 for 100/120 PCM
lines, e.g. S-09YS(ST)CY 8x2x0.6/1.2.
Coaxial cables for 75 wiring, e.g. 2YCCY 0.4/2.5.

NOTE
Use only twisted pair or coaxial copper cables with braided shielding!
If cables should be used without shielded twisted pairs, do not route up-link and downlink PCM lines in one common cable.
The maximum cable length depends on the attenuation of the cable, in order to fulfill the
requirements of minimum voltage levels to be provided at Abis interface according to
PCM standards.
The cable shielding must be connected to the relevant ground pins as close as possible
(in order to avoid EMC/RF interfering effects).

2.6.4.1

Abis-Interface for 120 Ohm Cable Impedance


Before starting the connection of the PCM cables at the Abis interface of the OVPT or
the ABISCON, prepare the cables as shown in the figure below.

Fig. 2.55

62

Preparation of a PCM-cable, 120 impedance

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Cut the cable to the required length (1).


Cut back the outer insulation approx.13 cm (2).
Remove approx. 11 cm of the braided shield (3).
Cut around the outer insulation and shift the insulation ring to the end of the braided
shield (4).Remove the foil shields and the additional plastic wires.
Remove 6 mm of the wires insulation.
Wrap the exposed cable screen, that will be attached at the stress relieving bracket.

NOTE
If screen-clamps should be used, the outer diameter of the PCM cable must not exceed
8 mm. The terminal block of the OVPT/ABISCON allows the connection of wires with a
cross-section range between 0.08 mm2 and 2,5 mm2 (#28 - #12 AWG).

Fig. 2.56

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Fastening of PCM cables at OVPT / ABISCON (120 )

Fix the cable at the stress-relieving by straps or screw down the screen clamps.
Insert the wires into the terminals of the OVPT / ABISCON.
Insert the additional wire (shielding potential) into one of the ground terminals (e.g.
no. 24).
Lead the additional wire and the uplink and downlink wires on the shortest route
(that means without sleeves) between the stress relieving and the screw terminals.
All unconnected PCM lines (4 wires per line) must be connected to one of the ground
terminals.

NOTE
The ABISCON / OVPT boards have delicate 1,0/2,3 connectors and monitoring interface connectors.
Please make sure that the wires and cables at these connectors are not under mechanical tension - use suitable stress relief measures!
The pin assignments of the ABISCON is equal to the pin assignments of the OVPT and
shown in the following figures.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

63

Down Link = RX

9 11 13 15 17

19

21 23 25 27

8 10 12 14 16 18

20

22 24 26 28

PCM 4

EXT SYNC A

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

EXT SYNC B

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

PCM 3

PCM 2

PCM 1

Up Link = TX
Fig. 2.57

Abis interface PCM0 Pin Assignment, 120 Ohm

Down Link = RX

A
PCM 8

9 11 13 15 17

19

21 23 25 27

8 10 12 14 16 18

20

22 24 26 28

PCM 7

PCM 6

PCM 5
Up Link = TX

Fig. 2.58

64

Abis interface PCM1 Pin Assignment, 120 Ohm

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.6.4.2

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Abis-Interface with ABISCONCX / OVPTCOAX 75 Ohm


The Abis interface to the peripheral link equipment is done by use of 9 1,0/2,3 coaxial
connectors, located at the ABISCONCX or at the OVPTCOAX (shown in Fig. 2.59).
holes for stress relieving

PCM line
connectors

Fig. 2.59

OVPTCOAX with 1,0/2,3 coaxial connectors, 75

For Abis cabling with 75 impedance use coaxial cable e.g. 2YCCY 0.4/2.5.
The coaxial cables will be prepared as follows:
Fix a 1,0/2,3-female connector for each PCM-up and down line at the end to be connected to the ABISCONCX / OVPTCOAX.
Connect the prepared cable to the matching connectors.
Use a torque spanner for 1,0/2,3 connector (35 Ncm).
Fix the cables at the holes for stress-relieving with cable ties.

NOTE
The ABISCON / OVPT boards have delicate 1,0/2,3 coaxial connectors. Make sure that
the wires and cables at these connectors are not fixed under mechanical tension - use
suitable stress relief measures!

signal

coax connector

signal

coax connector

PCM1-ULA

PCM3-DLA

PCM1-DLA

PCM4-ULA

PCM2-ULA

PCM4-DLA

PCM2-DLA

EXTSYNCA

PCM3-ULA

---

---

Tab. 2.11

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Pin Assignments of Abis interface PCM0, 75

65

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

signal

signal

coax connector

PCM5-ULA

PCM7-DLA

PCM5-DLA

PCM8-ULA

PCM6-ULA

PCM8-DLA

PCM6-DLA

---

PCM7-ULA

---

---

Tab. 2.12

66

coax connector

Pin Assignments of Abis interface PCM1, 75

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.6.4.3

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Abis-Interface without ABISCON / OVPT


Without the ABISCON / OVPT, if these function is not needed, a SUB-D25 female connector is the direct interface for the PCM links.

NOTE
Without OVPT no monitoring possibility is provided.

Pin no. SubD 25

Signal name

Function

PCM 1 - ULA

PCM Line 1 Up Link A

14

PCM 1 - ULB

PCM Line 1 Up Link B

GND/G

shield pair 1

PCM 1 - DLA

PCM Line 1 Down Link A

15

PCM 1 - DLB

PCM Line 1 Down Link B

GND/G

shield pair 2

PCM 2 - ULA

PCM Line 2 Up Link A

16

PCM 2 - ULB

PCM Line 2 Up Link B

18

GND/G

shield pair 3

PCM 2 - DLA

PCM Line 2 Down Link A

17

PCM 2 - DLB

PCM Line 2 Down Link B

18

GND/G

shield pair 4

PCM 3 - ULA

PCM Line 3 Up Link A

19

PCM 3 - ULB

PCM Line 3 Up Link B

GND/G

shield pair 5

PCM 3 - DLA

PCM Line 3 Down Link A

20

PCM 3 - DLB

PCM Line 3 Down Link B

GND/G

shield pair 6

PCM 4 - ULA

PCM Line 4 Up Link A

21

PCM 4 - ULB

PCM Line 4 Up Link B

11

GND/G

shield pair 7

10

PCM 4 - DLA

PCM Line 4 Down Link A

22

PCM 4 - DLB

PCM Line 4 Down Link B

23

GND/G

shield pair 8

12

EXTSYNCA

24

EXTSYNCB

25

GND/G

13

GND/G

Tab. 2.13

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

main cable shield

Pin Assignments of the PCM0 interface (SubD 25 connector)

67

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Pin no. SubD 25

Function

PCM 5 - ULA

PCM Line 5 Up Link A

14

PCM 5- ULB

PCM Line 5 Up Link B

GND/G

shield pair 1

PCM 5 - DLA

PCM Line 5 Down Link A

15

PCM 5 - DLB

PCM Line 5Down Link B

GND/G

shield pair 2

PCM 6 - ULA

PCM Line 6 Up Link A

16

PCM 6 - ULB

PCM Line 6 Up Link B

18

GND/G

shield pair 3

PCM 6 - DLA

PCM Line 6 Down Link A

17

PCM 6 - DLB

PCM Line 6 Down Link B

18

GND/G

shield pair 4

PCM 7 - ULA

PCM Line 7 Up Link A

19

PCM 7 - ULB

PCM Line 7 Up Link B

GND/G

shield pair 5

PCM 7 - DLA

PCM Line 7 Down Link A

20

PCM 7 - DLB

PCM Line 7 Down Link B

GND/G

shield pair 6

PCM 8 - ULA

PCM Line 8 Up Link A

21

PCM 8 - ULB

PCM Line 8 Up Link B

11

GND/G

shield pair 7

10

PCM 8 - DLA

PCM Line 8 Down Link A

22

PCM 8 - DLB

PCM Line 8 Down Link B

23

GND/G

shield pair 8

12

---

24

---

25

GND/G

13

GND/G

Tab. 2.14

68

Signal name

main cable shield

Pin Assignments of the PCM1 interface (SubD 25 connector)

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.6.4.4

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Monitoring Interfaces of ABISCON and OVPT


The ABISCON / OVPT provides 3 6pin DIN41616 test connectors for monitoring the
PCM lines.
The following tables show the pin assignment for the monitoring interfaces. The pin arrangement is shown in figure below.

6 5
connector 3
4 3
2 1
6 5
connector 2
4 3
2 1
6 5
connector 1
4 3
2 1
Fig. 2.60

Monitoring interfaces for PCM lines of ABISCON / OVPT

connector / pin

Signal name

connector / pin

Signal name

1- 1

PCM 1 - ULA

2- 4

PCM 3 - ULB

1- 2

PCM 1 - ULB

2- 5

PCM 3 - DLA

1- 3

PCM 1 - DLA

2- 6

PCM 3 - DLB

1- 4

PCM 1 - DLB

3- 1

PCM 4 - ULA

1- 5

PCM 2 - ULA

3- 2

PCM 4 - ULB

1- 6

PCM 2 - ULB

3- 3

PCM 4- DLA

2- 1

PCM 2 - DLA

3- 4

PCM 4- DLB

2- 2

PCM 2 - DLB

3- 5

EXTSYNCA

2- 3

PCM 3 - ULA

3- 6

EXTSYNCB

Tab. 2.15

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Pin Assignments of the monitoring interfaces PCM0

69

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

connector / pin

connector / pin

Signal name

1- 1

PCM 5 - ULA

2- 4

PCM 7 - ULB

1- 2

PCM 5 - ULB

2- 5

PCM 7 - DLA

1- 3

PCM 5 - DLA

2- 6

PCM 7 - DLB

1- 4

PCM 5 - DLB

3- 1

PCM 8 - ULA

1- 5

PCM 6 - ULA

3- 2

PCM 8 - ULB

1- 6

PCM 6 - ULB

3- 3

PCM 8 - DLA

2- 1

PCM 6 - DLA

3- 4

PCM 8 - DLB

2- 2

PCM 6 - DLB

3- 5

EXTSYNCA

2- 3

PCM 7 - ULA

3- 6

EXTSYNCB

Tab. 2.16

70

Signal name

Pin Assignments of the monitoring interfaces PCM1

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.6.5

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Alarm Collection Terminal - external Alarm Sensors


The access for cabling from external alarm sensors on site is the Alarm Collection Terminal for Base Rack (ACTM).
The ACTM provides 8 spring terminal blocks with 12 pins each for connecting of 48 external alarm sensors. Each terminal block allows the connection of wires with a crosssection in the range between 0,08 mm2 and 0,5 mm2 (#28 - #20 AWG).
The spring terminals are labelled X1 ... X10, the terminal blocks X1...X8 are used for
connection of external alarm sensors. At the terminal blocks X9 and X10 can be connected up to 8 different electrical consumers (e.g. relays). All cables will be attached to
the stress relieving bracket as shown in the figure below.
The following tables give information on the wiring of the terminals.

NOTE
For connection of external alarm sensors use cables with braided shield only.
Remove the outer insulation as shown in Fig. 2.55 for proper ground contact of the cable screen to the stress relieving bracket.

X4 12 1 X3 12 1 X2 12

X1 12

X9

1
8

X10 1
12

X7

X8
Fig. 2.61

1 12

1 12

12

X5

X6

ACTM terminal numbering

Pin no.

Signal name
X1

Signal name
X2

Signal name
X3

Signal name
X4

2, 4, 6, 8,10, 12

GND

GND

GND

GND

AL42P

AL36P

AL30P

AL24P

AL43P

AL37P

AL31P

AL25P

AL44P

AL38P

AL32P

AL26P

AL45P

AL39P

AL33P

AL27P

AL46P

AL40P

AL34P

AL28P

11

AL47P

AL41P

AL35P

AL29P

Tab. 2.17

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Pin Assignments ACTM Connector X1...X4

71

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Pin no.

Signal name
X5

Signal name
X6

Signal name
X7

Signal name
X8

2, 4, 6, 8,10, 12

GND

GND

GND

GND

AL0P

AL6P

AL12P

AL18P

AL1P

AL7P

AL13P

AL19P

AL2P

AL8P

AL14P

AL20P

AL3P

AL9P

AL15P

AL21P

AL4P

AL10P

AL16P

AL22P

11

AL5P

AL11P

AL17P

AL23P

Tab. 2.18

Pin Assignments ACTM Connector X5...X8

NOTE
The signal source of the command outputs on the X1...X8 clamping blocks must be a
switching contact. The resistance of the contacts in closed position must be lower than
100 Ohm.
It is not allowed to connect a voltage source to the alarm inputs.
The connection of alarm sensors located outside the building requires the installation of
the MK:OPEXAL which protects the ACTM against over-voltage.
The ACTM provides at the connectors X9 and X10 the possibility to connect up to 8 relay
contacts (e.g. relays with default contact open).

NOTE
The switched current must not exceed 100 mAAC/DC (contact closed) and the maximum
switched voltage is limited to 150 VAC or 125 VDC (contact open).
The maximum switching power is 10 W.

Pin no. X9

Pin no. X10

Signal name

CMD4_P

CMD0_P

CMD4_M

CMD0_M

CMD5_P

CMD1_P

CMD5_M

CMD1_M

CMD6_P

CMD2_P

CMD6_M

CMD2_M

CMD7_P

CMD3_P

CMD7_M

CMD3_M

Tab. 2.19

72

Signal name

Pin Assignments ACTM Connector X9, X10

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.6.6

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation of the Mounting Kit OPEXAL


If external alarm sensors are placed outside the building, the MK:OPEXAL (Overvoltage
Protection for external Alarms) is required.
Each MK:OPEXAL protects up to 10 alarm lines which are connected to the ACTM
against over-voltage.
Install the MK:OPEXAL in accordance to the following figures.
screw, dowel and washers 6 mm
ground wire

OPEXAL

cable ties

10 symmetric pair
cables
Fig. 2.62

Contents of the MK:OPEXAL

Drill two holes with 6 mm in diameter and min. 35 mm depth as shown in Fig. 2.63.
Insert the dowels.
Attach the MK:OPEXAL to the wall in vertical position and fix it with screws and
washers.
Connect the cables coming from the external alarm sensors at the left screw terminals of the overvoltage protectors.
Connect the symmetric pair cables at the right screw terminals of the overvoltage
protectors.
Attach the ground wire to the yellow / green clamping terminal (see Fig. 2.64).
Fix all cables with cable ties at the bracket of the MK:OPEXAL
Route the cables to the ACTM and the ground wire to the PE-plate of the EMI-panel
(see Fig. 2.65).

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

73

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

700 mm

220 mm

Fig. 2.63

diameter 6 mm
drill hole depth 35 mm

max. 30 mm
from the rack edge

Drilling sketch for MK:OPEXAL

cables from
external alarm sensors

Input side

ground wire
to PE-plate of EMI panel

Fig. 2.64

74

Output side

symmetric pair cables


to ACTM

Wall mounted MK:OPEXAL

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

cable tie

ACTM

PE-plate
ground bolt

Fig. 2.65

stress relieving bracket

Routing of external alarm cables

Fix external alarm cables with cables ties at the stress relieving bracket, so that a
proper electrical contact between the bracket and the cable screens is guaranteed.
Attach the ground wire to the bolt at the PE-plate.
Connect the external alarm cables at the matching spring terminals of the ACTM.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

75

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.6.7

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Installation of the MK:OPEXAL10V1


Due to the fact that external alarm sensors are located outside the building, the
MK:OPEXAL (Overvoltage Protection for external Alarms) that protects up to 10 alarm
lines is required.

OPEXAL10V1

ground terminal
module1

module0

to ACTM
SubD 25

optional

mounting bar
(MK:OPEXALBV1)

from external alarm sensors


ground wire to PE-plate

Fig. 2.66

Assembly Guideline

Fix the mounting bar MK:OPEXALBV1at the wall is as described in section 2.6.6.
To connect the internal and external cables perform the following steps:
1. Attach the inter-connection cable (delivered with the OPEXAL10V1) to the Sub D 25
female connector of the OPEXAL10V1.
2. Route the cable to the ACTM module in the EMI-panel of the base rack.
3. Secure the cable two times at the stress relieving facilities of the mounting bar.
4. Fix the inter-connection cable at the stress relieving bracket of the ACTM with cables
ties, so that the ground contact between cable screen and the bracket is provided.
5. Remove the plugs of the connection blocks X3 and X4 to connect the OPEXAL10V1
module no. 0 and X1, X2 to connect the (optional) module 1.
6. Setup the plugs with the connected wires at the matching blocks.

X4

X3

X2

X1

from module 1
from module 0

Fig. 2.67

76

cables from
OPEXAL10V1
S30864-X210-A105
S30864-X210-A105

ACTM, connection of the cables from OPEXAL10V1

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Quad
1

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Binder Tape Color


blue

orange

green

brown

grey

black

red

Tab. 2.20

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Wire Color

Plug X4 Pin Plug X3 Pin

white/blue

white/orange

blue

orange

white/blue

white/orange

blue

orange

white/blue

white/orange

10

blue

11

orange

12

white/blue

white/orange

blue

orange

white/blue

white/orange

blue

orange

white/blue

not used

white/orange

not used

blue

not used

orange

not used

white/blue

not used

white/orange

not used

blue

not used

orange

not used

OPEXAL10V1 Module 0 connection at ACTM

77

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Quad
1

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Binder Tape Color


blue

orange

green

brown

grey

black

red

Tab. 2.21

Wire Color

Plug X2 Pin Plug X1 Pin

white/blue

white/orange

blue

orange

white/blue

white/orange

blue

orange

white/blue

white/orange

10

blue

11

orange

12

white/blue

white/orange

blue

orange

white/blue

white/orange

blue

orange

white/blue

not used

white/orange

not used

blue

not used

orange

not used

white/blue

not used

white/orange

not used

blue

not used

orange

not used

OPEXAL10V1 Module 1 connection at ACTM

The ground pin of the OPEXAL10V1 has to be connected with the ground terminal,
mounted on the mounting bar MK:OPEXALBV1 (see Fig. 2.68).
The pre-fabricated wire will be delivered with the OPEXAL10V1.

78

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

ground pin

clamping block for connection


of external alarm sensors
Fig. 2.68

Connector assignment of the OPEXAL10V1

The external alarm sensors will be connected with screened twisted-pair cables at the
clamping block of the OPEXAL10V1. The clamping block allows the connection of wires
with a cross section in the range 0,08 - 0,5 mm2. The label of the module gives information about the terminal assignment of the clamping block.
In addition, the terminal assignment is displayed in the following figure.

valid alarm no. for module 0

AL37
AL25

AL38
AL26

AL39
AL27

AL40
AL28

AL_P
GND
AL_M
AL_P
GND
AL_M
AL_P
GND
AL_M
AL_P
GND
AL_M
AL_P
GND
AL_M

AL36
AL24

valid alarm no. for module 1

AL_P
GND
AL_M
AL_P
GND
AL_M
AL_P
GND
AL_M
AL_P
GND
AL_M
AL_P
GND
AL_M

1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 29
2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30

AL29
AL41
Fig. 2.69

AL30
AL42

AL31
AL43

AL32
AL44

AL33
AL45

Label with terminal assignment

NOTE
Do not lay the IN-and OUT cables in parallel.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

79

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.6.8

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

External Alarm Protection for ACTM (EAP)


If external alarm sensors are placed inside the building and the alarm lines more than
30 m long, the External Alarm Protection (EAP) has to be used.
The EAP module will be mounted on the EMI-panel of the rack as shown in Fig. 2.70.
A mounting bracket (2) is provided for the fixing the module. In addition the mounting kit
MK:HPDURV3 (1) is needed to mount the bracket.
Two prefabricated cables (4, 5) will be used for the connections between the EAP (3)
and the ACTM. Both cables are equipped with a SubD 37 female connector at the end
that will be connected at the EAP module and deisolated wire pairs for the connection
at the spring terminals of the ACTM.
One cable is used for transmission of the external alarms, the other one for transmission
of commands.
Two cables (6, 7) with 20 wire pairs each is needed for the connection between the EAP
module and the site specific alarm distribution panel.
These cables must be prepared on site. The end of each cable that should be connected
at the EAP has to be equipped with a SubD-37 female connector.
The pinning of the SubD-D37 connectors of the prefabricated cables and the color code
of the wire pairs is given in the following tables.
ground bolts

CAN IN

CAN OUT Serial IF

OVPT1

OVPT0

-48 V

CAN TEST LPA


MSU
PE-bolts

2
3
6
7

ACTM
Ext.1 CU 4...7

Ext.1 CU 0...3
Ext.2 CU 4...7

Ext.2 CU 0...3

Fig. 2.70

80

Mounting of the EAP on the top of the BS-240 II

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Pair No.
1

Tab. 2.22

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Color

Pin No.

white

blue

white

orange

white

green

white

brown

white

grey

10

red

11

blue

12

red

13

orange

14

red

15

green

16

red

17

brown

18

Pair No.
10

11

12

13

14

15

16

17

18

Color

Pin No.

red

19

grey

20

black

21

blue

22

black

23

orange

24

black

25

green

26

black

27

brown

28

black

29

grey

30

yellow

31

blue

32

yellow

33

orange

34

yellow

35

green

36

Pin / Wire assignment EAP-cable 1 and 2 (Sub-37, female)

81

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Pair No.
1

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Color
white

Tab. 2.23

82

X 10

blue

white

orange

white

green

white

brown

white

X8

grey

red

blue
7

Block/Terminal

X8

Pair No.
10

orange

red

green

red

brown

10

red

Block/Terminal
X8

grey
11

12

13

14

15

red

Color

black

17

18

12
X4

blue

black

orange

black

green

black

brown

black

grey
16

11

X4

10

yellow

11

blue

12

yellow

X3

orange

yellow

green

Wire / Terminal assignment EAP-cable 2 at ACTM

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Pair No.
1

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Color
white

Tab. 2.24

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

X9

blue

white

orange
3

Block/Terminal

X9

green

white

brown

8
X5

10

grey

red

blue

red

orange

red

green

red

brown

10

Color
red

Block/Terminal
X5

grey
11

white

white

Pair No.

12

13

14

15

16

17

18

11
12

black

X6

blue

X6

black

orange

black

green

black

brown

black

grey

10

yellow

11

blue

12

yellow

X7

orange

yellow

green

Wire / Terminal assignment EAP-cable 1 at ACTM

83

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.6.9

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Alarm Collection Terminal ACTC - internal Alarms / DC Supply


The ACTC is used as a connection board to support single connectors for the internal
alarms (FAN, heat exchanger, temperature sensor, rack in service...) and the DC supply
for the FANs, heat exchangers, microwave equipment and smoke sensor.
The ACTC is located in the DC panel of each rack (see Fig. 2.71).

X17 X18 X19


X28 X29 X30
X31 X32 X33 X37
X34 X35 X36

Fig. 2.71

X1 X2

24

X26

X38 X39 X40

Connector arrangement at ACTC (BS-240)

The following tables provides information about the connecting of internal alarm sensors
at the ACTC.

84

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

AL

Connector / Pin on ACTC

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Base / Extension Rack

Service1 / Service2 Rack

Rack 0, 1, 2

Rack 3...7

Front side X1

RDO (High Active)

RDO (High Active)

Rear side X20

FAN0 (High Active)

FAN0 (High Active)

Rear side X21

FAN1 (High Active)

FAN1 (High Active)

Rear side X22

FAN2 (High Active)

FAN2 (High Active)

Rear side X23

FAN3 (High Active)

FAN3 (High Active)

Rear side X24

FAN4 (High Active)

FAN4 (if installed) (High Active)

Rear side X25

FAN5 (High Active)

FAN5 (if installed) (High Active)

Front side X17, X26 / 11,12

Enva0 (High / low Active)

Enva0 (High / low Active)

Front side X18, X26 / 9,10

Enva1 (High / low Active)

Enva1 (High / low Active)

Front side X19, X26 / 7, 8

Enva2 (High / low Active)

Enva2 (High / low Active)

10

Front side X2

Enva3 (High / low Active)

Enva3 (High / low Active)

11 3)

Front side X37, X26 / 5, 6

Enva4 (High / low Active)

Enva4 (High / low Active)

4)

Front side X38, X39, X40

Enva5 (High / low Active)

Enva5 (High / low Active)

13

Rear side X41

Enva6 (OVP) 1)(High Active)

Enva6 (OVP) 1) (High Active)

14

Front side X26 / 3, 4

Enva7 (High / low Active)

Enva7 (High / low Active)

15

Front side X28...36, X26 / 1, 2


(all connected in parallel)

Enva8 (High / low Active)

Enva8 (High / low Active)

7 2)
8

2)

12

Notes:

1) High Active if OVP is installed


2) alarm connection on clamping block X26 in parallel with dedicated connector at the ACTC rear side
3) alarm connection on clamping block X26 in parallel with dedicated connector at the ACTC front side
4) connectors X38, X39 and X40 connected in series inside ACTC and wired to alarm ENVA5
General: EnVAX is LMT relevant syntax
Tab. 2.25

ACTC alarms for BS-240 rack types (not for BS-240XL)

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

85

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

X17 X18 X19


X28 X29 X30
24

X31 X32 X33 X37


X34 X35 X36

Fig. 2.72

AL

X26

X1 X2

X38 X39 X40 X42

Connector arrangement at ACTC (BS-240XL)

Connector / Pin on ACTC

Base / Extension Rack

Service1 / Service2 Rack

Rack 0, 1, 2

Rack 3...7

Front side X1

RDO (High Active)

RDO (High Active)

Rear side X20

FAN0 (High Active)

FAN0 (High Active)

Rear side X21

FAN1 (High Active)

FAN1 (High Active)

Rear side X22

FAN2 (High Active)

FAN2 (High Active)

Rear side X23

FAN3 (High Active)

FAN3 (High Active)

Rear side X24

FAN4 (High Active)

FAN4 (if installed) (High Active)

Rear side X25

FAN5 (High Active)

FAN5 (if installed) (High Active)

Rear side X43

FAN6 (High Active)

FAN6 (not installed) (High Active)

Rear side X44

FAN7 (High Active)

FAN7 (not installed) (High Active)

93)

Front side X17-X19, X26 / 7, 8

Enva2 (High / low Active)

Enva2 (High / low Active)

Front side X2

Enva3 (High / low Active)

Enva3 (High / low Active)

Front side X37, X26 / 5, 6

Enva4 (High / low Active)

Enva4 (High / low Active)

Front side X38, X39, X40, X42

Enva5 (High / low Active)

Enva5 (High / low Active)

10
11

3)

12 4)

1)(High Active)

Enva6 (OVP) 1) (High Active)

13

Rear side X41

Enva6 (OVP)

14

Front side X26 / 3, 4

Enva7 (High / low Active)

Enva7 (High / low Active)

15

Front side X28...X36, X26 / 1, 2


(all connected in parallel)

Enva8 (High / low Active)

Enva8 (High / low Active)

1) High Active if OVP is installed


2) alarm connection on clamping block X26 in parallel with dedicated connector at the ACTC rear side
3) alarm connection on clamping block X26 in parallel with dedicated connector at the ACTC front side
4) connectors X38, X39 and X40 connected in series inside ACTC and wired to alarm ENVA5
General: EnVAX is LMT relevant syntax
Tab. 2.26

86

ACTC alarms for BS-240 XL

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.6.10

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Alarm Collection Terminal ACTC-3 - internal Alarms / DC Supply


The ACTC-3 collects all internal alarms of the BS-240 II / 240XL II. The board is located
in the DC panel of Base- and Extension rack, AD-panel of Service1A rack and in the LEpanel of the Service2 rack.

X37

X48

X20

Fig. 2.73

AL

X45
1

24

Connector arrangement at the ACTC-3

Connector / Pin on ACTC

Base / Extension Rack

Service1A / Service2 Rack

Rack 0, 1, 2

Rack 3...7

Front side X48

RDO (High Active)

RDO (High Active)

Rear side X47

FAN0 (High Active)

FAN0 (High Active)

Rear side X21

FAN1 (High Active)

FAN1 (High Active)

Rear side X22

FAN2 (High Active)

FAN2 (High Active)

4 2)

Rear side X23, Front side X45 / 23, 24

FAN3 (High Active)

FAN3 (High Active)

2)

Rear side X24, Front side X45 / 21, 22

FAN4 (High Active)

FAN4 (if installed) (High Active)

6 2)

Rear side X25, Front side X45 / 19, 20

FAN5 (High Active)

FAN5 (if installed) (High Active)

2)

Rear side X43, Front side X45 / 17, 18

Enva0 (High / low Active)

Enva0 (High / low Active)

8 2)

Front side X45 / 15, 16

Enva1 (High / low Active)

Enva1 (High / low Active)

Front side X45 / 13, 14

Enva2 (High / low Active)

Enva2 (High / low Active)

Front side X45 / 11, 12

Enva3 (High / low Active)

Enva3 (High / low Active)

Front side X37, X45 / 9, 10

Enva4 (High / low Active)

Enva4 (High / low Active)

Front side X45 / 7, 8

Enva5 (High / low Active)

Enva5 (High / low Active)

10
11

3)

12
13

2)

1)(High Active)

Enva6 (OVP) 1) (High Active)

Rear side X41, Front side X45 / 5, 6

Enva6 (OVP)

14

Front side X45 / 3, 4

Enva7 (High / low Active)

Enva7 (High / low Active)

15

Front side X45 / 1, 2

Enva8 (High / low Active)

Enva8 (High / low Active)

1) High Active if OVP is installed


2) alarm connection on clamping block X45 in parallel with dedicated connector at the ACTC rear side
3) alarm connection on clamping block X45 in parallel with dedicated connector at the ACTC front side
General: EnVAX is LMT relevant syntax
Tab. 2.27

ACTC alarms for BS-240 II

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

87

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

AL

Connector / Pin on ACTC

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Base / Extension Rack

Service1A / Service2 Rack

Rack 0, 1, 2

Rack 3...7

Front side X48

RDO (High Active)

RDO (High Active)

Rear side X47

FAN0 (High Active)

FAN0 (High Active)

Rear side X21

FAN1 (High Active)

FAN1 (High Active)

Rear side X22

FAN2 (High Active)

FAN2 (High Active)

2)

Rear side X23, Front side X45 / 23, 24

FAN3 (High Active)

FAN3 (High Active)

5 2)

Rear side X24, Front side X45 / 21, 22

FAN4 (High Active)

FAN4 (High Active)

2)

Rear side X25, Front side X45 / 19, 20

FAN5 (High Active)

FAN5 (High Active)

7 2)

Rear side X43, Front side X45 / 17, 18

FAN6 (High Active)

FAN6 (High Active)

Rear side X44, Front side X45 / 15,16

FAN7 (High Active)

FAN7 (High Active)

Front side X45 / 13, 14

Enva2 (High / low Active)

Enva2 (High / low Active)

10

Front side X45 / 11, 12

Enva3 (High / low Active)

Enva3 (High / low Active)

11 3)

Front side X37, X45 / 9, 10

Enva4 (High / low Active)

Enva4 (High / low Active)

12

Front side X45 / 7, 8

Enva5 (High / low Active)

Enva5 (High / low Active)

13 2)

Rear side X41, Front side X45 / 5, 6

Enva6 (OVP) 1)(High Active)

Enva6 (OVP) 1) (High Active)

14

Front side X45 / 3, 4

Enva7 (High / low Active)

Enva7 (High / low Active)

15

Front side X45 / 1, 2

Enva8 (High / low Active)

Enva8 (High / low Active)

2)

1) High Active if OVP is installed


2) alarm connection on clamping block X45 in parallel with dedicated connector at the ACTC rear side
3) alarm connection on clamping block X45 in parallel with dedicated connector at the ACTC front side
General: EnVAX is LMT relevant syntax
Tab. 2.28

88

ACTC alarms for BS-240XL II rack types

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.6.11

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Alarm Collection Terminal ACTC-4 - internal Alarms / DC Supply


The ACTC-4 collects all internal alarms of the BS-24o II and BS-240XL II racks and is
located at the DC panel of the Base- and Extension racks, AD-panel of each Service1A
rack and at the LE-panel of Service2 rack.

LMU

X1

Fig. 2.74

Smoke

RDO

X2

X3

24

X4

Connector arrangement at the ACTC-4

The following table provides information about the connection of internal alarm sensors
at the ACTC-4 for BS-240 II.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

89

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

AL

Connector / Pin on ACTC

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Base / Extension

Service1A / Service2

Rack 0, 1, 2

Rack 3, ..., Rack 7

Front side X3

RDO (High Active)

RDO (High Active)

Top of PCB X17

FAN0 (High Active)

FAN0 (High Active)

Top of PCB X13

FAN1 (High Active)

FAN1 (High Active)

Top of PCB X16

FAN2 (High Active)

FAN2 (High Active)

Top of PCB X12, Front side X4/ 23, 24

FAN3 (High Active)

FAN3 (High Active)


(if not installed ENVA9)

5 2)

Top of PCB X15, Front side X4 / 21, 22

FAN4 (High Active)

FAN4 (High Active)


(if not installed ENVA10)

6 2)

Top of PCB X11, Front side X4 / 19, 20

FAN5 (High Active)

FAN5 (High Active)


(if not installed ENVA11)

7 2)

Top of PCB X14, Front side X4 / 17, 18

Enva0 (High / low Active)

Enva0 (High / low Active)

2)

Top of PCB X10, Front side X4 / 15, 16

Enva1 (High / low Active)

Enva1 (High / low Active)

9 4)

Top of PCB X26, Front side X4 / 13, 14

Enva2 (High / low Active)

Enva2 (High / low Active) (MBR) 5)

10 4)

Top of PCB X26, Front side X4 / 11, 12

Enva3 (High / low Active)

Enva3 (High / low Active) (BBR) 5)

11 3)

Front side X2, Front side X4 / 9, 10

Enva4 (SMOKE)

Enva4 (SMOKE) (High / low Active)

3
4

2)

(High / low Active)

12 4)

Top of PCB X26, Front side X4 / 7, 8 6)

Enva5 (High / low Active)

Enva5 (High / low Active) 6) (MAJ) 5)

13 2)

Top of PCB X7/OVP, Front side X4/ 5,6

Enva6 (OVP) 1)(High / low Active) Enva6 (OVP) 1) (High / low Active)

14 4)

Top of PCB X26, Front side X4 / 3, 4

Enva7 (High / low Active)

Enva7 (High / low Active) (BCHF) 5)

15 4)

Top of PCB X26, Front side X4 / 1, 2

Enva8 (High / low Active)

Enva8 (High / low Active) (48OTB) 5)

1) High Active if OVP is installed, 2) alarm connection on clamping block X4 (front) in parallel with dedicated
connector at top of ACTC-PCB, 3) alarm connection on clamping block X4 in parallel with dedicated connector
at the ACTC front, 4) alarm connection on clamping block X4 in parallel with dedicated SubD pin of link to
AC7DC, 5) AC/DC alarms (all high active) are only relevant for Service1A cabinet, 6) Enva5 (AL 12) is not available, if MAJ alarm is activated (X24 jumper setting: pins 1 and 2 connected), General: ENVAX is LMT relevant
syntax
Tab. 2.29

90

ACTC-4 alarms for BS-240 II racks

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

AL

Connector / Pin on ACTC

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Base / Extension

Service1A / Service2

Rack 0, 1

Rack 4, ..., Rack 7

Front side X3

RDO (High Active)

RDO (High Active)

Top of PCB X17

FAN0 (High Active)

FAN0 (High Active)

Top of PCB X13

FAN1 (High Active)

FAN1 (High Active)

Top of PCB X16

FAN2 (High Active)

FAN2 (High Active)

2)

Top of PCB X12, Front side X4 / 23, 24

FAN3 (High Active)

FAN3 (High Active)


(if not installed ENVA9)

5 2)

Top of PCB X15, Front side X4 / 21, 22

FAN4 (High Active)

FAN4 (High Active)


(if not installed ENVA10)

6 2)

Top of PCB X11, Front side X4 / 19, 20

FAN5 (High Active)

FAN5 (High Active)


(if not installed ENVA11)

7 2)

Top of PCB X14, Front side X4 / 17, 18

Enva0 (High / low Active)

Enva0 (High / low Active)

Top of PCB X10, Front side X4 / 15,16

Enva1 (High / low Active)

Enva1 (High / low Active)

9 4)

Top of PCB X26, Front side X4 / 13, 14

Enva2 (High / low Active)

Enva2 (High / low Active) (MBR) 5)

10 4)

Top of PCB X26, Front side X4 / 11, 12

Enva3 (High / low Active)

Enva3 (High / low Active) (BBR) 5)

11 3)

Front side X2, Front side X4 / 9, 10

Enva4 (SMOKE)

Enva4 (SMOKE) (High / low Active)

2)

(High / low Active)

12 4)

Top of PCB X26, Front side X4 / 7, 8 6)

Enva5 (High / low Active)

Enva5 (High / low Active) 6) (MAJ) 5)

13 2)

Top of PCB X7/OVP, Front side X4 / 5, 6

Enva6 (OVP) 1) (High / low Active) Enva6 (OVP) 1) (High / low Active)

14 4)

Top of PCB X26, Front side X4 / 3, 4

Enva7 (High / low Active)

Enva7 (High / low Active) (BCHF) 5)

15 4)

Top of PCB X26, Front side X4 / 1, 2

Enva8 (High / low Active)

Enva8 (High / low Active) (48OTB) 5)

1) High Active if OVP is installed, 2) alarm connection on clamping block X4 (front) in parallel with dedicated
connector at top of ACTC-PCB, 3) alarm connection on clamping block X4 in parallel with dedicated connector
at the ACTC front, 4) alarm connection on clamping block X4 in parallel with dedicated SubD pin of link to
AC7DC, 5) AC/DC alarms (all high active) are only relevant for Service1A cabinet, 6) Enva5 (AL 12) is not available, if MAJ alarm is activated (X24 jumper setting: pins 1 and 2 connected), General: ENVAX is LMT relevant
syntax
Tab. 2.30

ACTC-4 alarms for BS-240 II racks


The spring terminal block of the ACTC allows the connection of wires in a diameter
range of 0.08 mm2... 0.5 mm2

NOTE
It is recommended to use an opto-coupler for open collector alarm I/F to be connected
to the ACTC-3. This is to avoid detection failures due to galvanic coupling of noise from
external to internal signal ground.
maximum "Alarm Low"-voltage: UceAL-AL_GND < 400mV at Ic = 2mA
minimum "Alarm High"-resistance: RceAL-AL_GND > 500 kOhm
If a switching contact (relay) is used as an alarm source I/F, the maximum "Alarm Low"resistance RAL-AL_GND less than 200 Ohm.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

91

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.6.12

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Local Maintenance Terminal (LMT) Interface


A SubD 15 female connector and the RJ45 socket, located at the DC panel of the Base
rack, is the interface for connecting a Local Maintenance Terminal (LMT) for commissioning and maintenance purposes.
Pin No.

Signal Name

Pin No.

---

LMT_SA

11

LMT_RB

LMT_TA

---

12

LMT_IB

LMT_CA

GND

13

LMT_SB

LMT_RA

GND

14

---

LMT_IA

10

LMT_TB

15

---

Tab. 2.31

Pin No.

Signal name

Pin Assignments of the LMT interface

RJ45 Pin No.

Signal Name

RJ45 Pin No.

Signal name

10BT_TD+

10BT_TD-

10BT_RD+

---

---

10BT_RD-

---

---

Tab. 2.32

92

Signal name

Pin Assignments of the LMT RJ45 interface

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.6.13

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Antenna Connections
The BTSE has to be connected to the transmit and receive antennas. The antenna configuration and the required cabling are dependent on the site and the type of combining.
For detailed information refer to the site-specific documentation or use the corresponding customer documents.
For installation and service purposes it is useful to know, which hardware is connected
to which cell. The numbering, seen from the top of the antenna pole, starts at an azimuth
angle of 0 (north) and rotates clockwise.
The first existing cell whose beam centre line lies at 0 or more is defined as cell 0 or
sector 0. The next one following in the same direction cell is cell 1 etc.
In case of omni cell the cell no. is 0.
0

sector 2
sector angle

directional antenna

beam centre line

pole
sector width 120

sector 0

sector 1

Fig. 2.75

Cell numbering (top view from the antenna pole)

For detailed antenna configuration, refer to the site-specific documentation.

2.6.13.1

Preparation of Antenna Jumper Cables


Short jumper cables with a max. diameter 1/2 have to be used for connections between
the antenna cables and the front connectors of the combining modules, because the
thick cables from the antenna are not able to enter the racks.
With regard to the overvoltage protection, it is recommended to ground the outer conductor of antenna feeder cables where they are connected with the jumper cables outside the BTSE.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

93

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

These jumper cables must be fabricated of 1/2 highly flexible coaxial cable on-site, if no
pre-fabricated cables should be used.
Fabricate the jumper cables in steps as shown in the following figures.

cable trimming tool

hot air gun


(or propane/ butane blow torch)

cable knife
open-ended spanners
(jaw opening 21mm and
25 mm)

Fig. 2.76

Tools for jumper fabrication

heat shrink sleeve

fitting ring

heat protection tape


cleaning tissue

corrugation nut
connector head
emery paper

Fig. 2.77

94

Parts of the connector unit kit (example)

Measure the distance between the end of the antenna feeder cable and the front
connectors of the combining modules.
Cut the cable to the required length. Do not deform cable outer conductor, by using
too much pressure during the cutting process!

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2
rotate clockwise
1

Fig. 2.78

Using the trimming tool

Fig. 2.79

Removal of isolation and deburring of inner conductor

heat shrink sleeve

fitting ring

Fig. 2.80

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Removal of metal particles

95

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

fitting ring
connector head

corrugation nut

Fig. 2.81

Assembly of the connector unit

20 mm

Fig. 2.82

Fixing of connector unit, removal of outer insulation

heat protection tape

heat shrink sleeve

Fig. 2.83

96

Handling of heat protection tape and shrink sleeve

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

hot air stream

remove extra length


of heat protection tape

Fig. 2.84

Shrinkage and removal of visible heat protection tape

The jumper cables must be routed through the cable feeding module forward to the
7/16 front connectors of DUAMCO/FICOM and to N-type male connector of DIAMCO.

NOTE
Fix the jumper cables at 7/16 connectors with a torque wrench set to 25 Nm.
N-type connectors should work when 'finger tight". There doesn't appear to be a consensus on how much torque this is in detail. Connector suppliers recommends a torque
of approx. 1,00 Nm.

NOTE
Note that being able to close the doors means that the depth of the right angle connector
is not allowed to exceed 45 mm.
max. 45 mm

max. 1/2 jumper cable


width across flats 32
Fig. 2.85

Max. dimensions of the antenna connectors

Connect the antenna cables to the combining equipment as follows:


Unscrew the front part of the cable feeding module.
Route the antenna jumpers to the rack, which has to be connected.
For grounding remove outer insulation approx. 60 mm for proper contact with the
metal lids of the cable feeding module (see Fig. 2.88).
Feed the jumpers through the cable feeding module forward to the front connectors
of antenna combiners.
Fix the jumpers at the connectors TX/RX of combiners.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

97

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

98

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Bend the jumpers into the correct position for easy closing of cable feeding module.
Screw the front part of the cable feeding module in its original position.

Fig. 2.86

Opening of the cable feeding module

Fig. 2.87

Antenna jumpers at the cable feeding module

Fig. 2.88

Antenna jumpers at the cable feeding module

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.6.14

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation of the Tower Mounted Amplifier


A Tower Mounted Amplifier will be used to reach a BTS sensitivity better than GSM requirements at the antenna connector and to compensate a high antenna cable loss.
The TMA should placed as close to the antenna as possible. It will be supplied and supervised by the multicoupling equipment (DIAMCO or DUAMCO) in the rack it is connected to.
When using a DUAMCO as antenna combiner inside the rack, only one feeder cable is
needed between the TMA and the BTS (for both TX and RX signals) due to full duplex
architecture of the TMA.

TMA

TMA
Base Rack

DUAMCO

Fig. 2.89

CU

Position of TMA (DUAMCO combiner used)

If a FICOM as antenna combiner inside the rack, the TMA is used in conjunction with a
DIAMCO and it only amplifies the overall BTS uplink signal.

TMA

TMA
Base Rack
DIAMCO

CU

FICOM

Fig. 2.90

Position of TMA (FICOM combiner used)

If a TMA used together with HPDU, a DUBIAS is required for powering and signalling of
the TMA.The configuration is shown in figure below and the installation in Fig. 2.91

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

99

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

TMA

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

TMA

RX8
DIAMCO

RX2
RX1

CU8
DUBIAS

Fig. 2.91

HPDU

FICOM

CU2
CU1

Configuration with HPDU, DUBIAS and TMA

to TMA
BIAS DIAMCO
PATH
RXIN
HPDU2

From FICOM

Fig. 2.92

2.6.14.1

ANT0 ANT1

RXOUT

DIAMCO

Installation of TMA and DUBIAS

Installation of the TMADV1


Two 7/16 female connectors, located at the bottom of the TMADV1 (lettered ANT and
BTS) are the interfaces for connection of the 1/2 antenna jumper cables that connect
the TMADV1 with the antenna and the antenna feeder cable towards to the BTS.
The TMA can be pole-or wall mounted in vertical position only.
The location of the external interfaces is shown in Fig. 2.93.
The mounting of the TMA may be done as follows in accordance with Fig. 2.94.
While still on ground, join each of the 2 brackets with one screw M8, but leave the
brackets open. Be sure not to loose the remaining 2 screws.
Position the TMA on the mast/pole and tighten the remaining 2 screws.
Connect the TMADV1 with the jumper cables to the antenna feeder cable and the
antenna. Do not forget to consider thermal dimensional changes of the antenna
feeder cable.
Attach the ground wire to the ground screw of the TMADV1 and connect the wire at
nearest grounding facility at the mast or pole. The ground wires eyes must have the
right size for the TMAs M8 ground screw and the cable should be have a cross section not less than 16 mm2.

100

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

ANT
(input/output
towards TX/RX antenna)

BTS
(input/output
towards BTS)

grounding point

Fig. 2.93

Bottom view of the TMADV1 (Single TMA)

NOTE
Note, that the max. diameter of the mast do not exceed 140 mm, if the fixing material will
be used as shown in the following figure.

Fig. 2.94

TMA with mounting brackets

The TMADV1 may be also mounted on a wall by means of suitable screws (not supplied
with the TMADV1)
The corresponding holes in the mounting plate have a diameter of 9 mm. The proper
way of mounting the TMA on a wall varies from case to case. The best method can only
be decided by the installer. Please note, however, that the wall itself does probably not
provide adequate grounding, it may be insulated.

WARNING
It is absolutely necessary to prepare and connect an adequate grounding cable to the
TMAs grounding point. Pay attention to the thermals dimensional changes of the antenna feeder cable.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

101

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.6.14.2

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Installation of the STMAx / DTMAx


The Single Tower Mounted Amplifiers (STMAx) and the Dual Tower Mounted Amplifiers
(DTMAx) are the RF units that provide the means to feed the downlink signal to one
TX/RX antenna and to amplify, with low noise figure, the uplink signal coming from the
same TX/RX antenna.
The DTMAx / STMAx should be placed as close to the antenna as possible. It will be
supplied and supervised by the multicoupling equipment in the rack it is connected to.
Various versions for different frequency bands of the DTMA and DTMARET are available.
Single Tower Mounted Amplifier

Fig. 2.95

Example of STMAx and DTMAx

Single Tower Mounted Amplifier

Fig. 2.96

Dual Tower Mounted Amplifier

Dual Tower Mounted Amplifier

Rear side of STMAx and DTMAx (example)

NOTE
It is recommended to mount the DTMAx and the STMAx at pole or wall in a vertical position, so that the ground screw of the units is pointing downwards.
In certain cases is the mounting in a horizontal position (e.g., on cable runways) possible, it depends on the environmental conditions.
The DTMAx and the STMAx provides 7/16 female connectors for the connection with
the BTSE (lettered COM) and the antenna (lettered ANT).

102

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Each DTMAx / STMAx shall be grounded to the pole, therefore a grounding wire has to
be prepared for each device on site.
The unit provides a ground screw with a locking washer attached to it and a threaded
hole for connection of the grounding wire. The grounding wire cable lug must have the
right size for the M8 ground screw. The cross section of the ground wire must be not less
than 16 mm2.
The other end of the grounding wire should be safely connected to a well grounded point
on the pole.
Hose clips surrounds the pole and are fitted into the corresponding openings of the
mounting plate (see rear view of the devices). This is the situation just before tightening
the hose clips.
hose clips

tighten

tighten

Fig. 2.97

Example of pole mounting with the STMAx (

For the mounting, the following steps can generally be recommended:


1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.

Place the unit in its final mounting position at the pole.


Secure the unit with a tensioning belt.
Close the hose clip loosely around the pole.
Tighten the hose clip screws carefully, but do not over-tighten (see Fig. 2.97).
Remove the tensioning belt.
Connect the DTMAx / STMAx via a 1/2 jumper cable to the antenna feeder cable
(connector COM) and to the antenna jumper cable (connector ANT). The torque
must be 25 - 30 Nm.
7. Connect the grounding wire with the ground screw of the unit. Tighten the connection to a torque of 5 Nm.
8. The use of self-vulcanizing tape as an environmental protection of the connectors is
recommended.
The DTMAx / STMAx may be mounted on a wall by means of suitable screws and dowels (not supplied with the device).

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

103

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

The corresponding holes in the mounting plate have a diameter of 9 mm. The proper
way of mounting the device on a wall varies from case to case. The best method can
only be decided by the installer. Please note, however, that the wall itself probably does
not provide adequate grounding, it may be insulated.

i
!

104

NOTE
It is absolutely necessary to prepare and connect an adequate grounding wire to the
STMAx / DTMAx nearest grounding point. The cross section of the ground wires should
be not less than 16 mm2.

NOTE
Pay attention to the thermal dimensional changes of the antenna feeder cables.

WARNING
Pay attention to the regulations for working in dangerous heights. Do not work without
fall protection equipment.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.7

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Rack Completion
The BS-240 / 240XL / 240 II / 240XL II racks are shipped including equipment components, pre-installed by the manufacturer in accordance with customer configuration:
Sub-rack, which holds several boards and modules
DC panel
Backplanes (multi-layer PC-boards, which are mounted at the rear side of the subrack) and internal cabling
Heaters and fan units
Core modules and carrier related modules
AC/DC converters
Semi-rigid cables for setup of the system cabling
The following items are planned for installation after setup of the racks on site:
Backup batteries
Cabling between the racks (e.g. battery cabling, DC-cabling, CAN-BUS)
Link equipment
For cable routing from one rack into another one two ways can be used. The CAN-Bus
cables and the SELIC-Bus cables will be routed above the EMI panels.
Without leaving the EMC-protected area (e.g. DC power supply, battery cables), an interconnection hole in upper area of the side walls of each rack is provided. The holes
are covered by plates for single racks and the end-racks of a row.
The two mounting kits EMC as shown in the following figure contain all of the parts that
are needed for connection of two racks.
MK:EMCRV1 (BS-240 / 240XL)

MK:EMCR-2V1 (BS-240 II / 240XL II)

4
2

3
1) sealing stripes
Fig. 2.98

2) Contact springs

Contents of the connection kits

Mount the parts of the connection kits in the following order:


Loosen the security screws M3 of the cover part (Fig. 2.99) or break out the preperforated part of the appropriate side wall (Fig. 2.100).
BS-240 / 240XL: Setup the 8 sealing stripes (1) at the edges of the holes of both
adjoined racks. Move the racks close together.
BS-240 II / 240XL II: Move at first the adjoining racks close together. Push the 4 contact springs (2) over the adjacent edges of both racks.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

105

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Connect the racks to one common unit with nut and screw M8x20 (3) and install the
ground wire (4) between the ground bolts of both racks (Fig. 2.101).

unscrew the 10 screws M3

Fig. 2.99

Setup of EMC sealing stripes (BS-240 / 240XL)

2
Fig. 2.100 Setup of EMC sealing contact springs (BS-240 II / 240XL II)

106

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Fig. 2.101 Connection of the racks (example with BS-240)

2.7.1

Preparation of the Top Cover


Before starting the connection of external cables, prepare the top cover for later routing
the cables through the cover to the infrastructure equipment on site.
For this purpose the top cover provides removable pieces as shown in the figure below.
The required number of pieces can be removed in easy manner by breaking out at the
perforation. After that refinish the paint coat at all cracks with the paint retouch kit (Siemens Serial No. A500-C101-B261).
The sharp edges of the break-outs will be covered with the sealing profile tape (Siemens
Serial No. C42127-Z1-C661). It will be delivered in 100 cm sections and must be cutted
in the required length.

Fig. 2.102 Paint retouch of the top cover

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

107

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

sealing profile tape


Fig. 2.103 Placement of the sealing profile tapes

108

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.7.2

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Overview of Battery Sets


To enable easier transportation and setup of Service Racks, they can be delivered without backup batteries. The battery tray can be equipped with different types of batteries.
The installed battery type depends on the required backup time. Each battery set consist
of 4 batteries. If a label relevant to the characteristics of the batteries is delivered, then
should be this label placed on the door of the rack.
The following battery types can be installed in the first generation of BS-240 / 240XL.
Supplier

BATTPACK type

MK:BATTPACK type

Capacity

Excide, A400/85

BATTPACKV1

MK:BATTPACKV1

85 Ah

Oerlikon, 12CP80

BATTPACKV2

MK:BATTPACKV2

80 Ah

Oerlikon, 12CP100/19

BATTPACKV3

MK:BATTPACKV3

100 Ah

EnerSys, 12V92F

BATTPACKV4

MK:BATTPACKV4

92 Ah

Tab. 2.33

Overview of backup battery sets (BS-240 / BS-240XL)

Tab. 2.34 shows the battery types, which can be installed in the racks of BS-240 II and
BS-240XL II.
Supplier

BATTPACK type

MK:BATTPACK type

Capacity

EnerSys, 12V92F

BATTPACKV4

MK:BATTPACKV4

92 Ah

Oerlikon, 12C@2000

BATTPACKV5

MK:BATTPACKV5

55 Ah

Oerlikon, 12C@2000

BATTPACKV7

MK:BATTPACKV5

55 Ah

Tab. 2.34

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Overview of backup battery sets BS-240II / BS-240XL II)

109

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.7.3

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Installation of Backup Batteries in Service Rack


NOTE
BS-240 / 240 XL: As up to 2 AC/DC frames can be installed in the Service1 rack. An
identification of the AC/DC controllers is needed. The first AC/DC frame is installed in
the upper position.
Dip switches at the front of the AC/DC controller are used for selecting the Slot ID. The
following combinations are not permitted: Slot ID bit 0/1 = ON/ON or OFF/OFF. The
capacity of the installed battery systems has to be selected at the Dip switch rows of the
AC/DC controller. For detailed information refer to ITMN:BTSE.

Slot ID bit 0
upper frame (AC/DC 1)

ON

OFF

lower frame (AC/DC 2), if installed

OFF

ON

Tab. 2.35

Slot ID bit 1

Selection of Slot ID (BS-240 / 240 XL)

NOTE
In a BS-240XL / XL II Service2 rack the extra space must not be used for a fourth set of
batteries.
If the Service1A / Service2 racks are equipped with battery trays MK:BATTFIXCB, before setup of the batteries, the spacer strips (1) have to be placed at the rear and the
front edge of the battery tray. Additional spacer blocks (2) are used to provide a distance
of 10 mm between the batteries. They will be fixed at the batteries as shown in the figure
below.

Fig. 2.104 Parts for battery fixing

110

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

bracket

spacer strips

Fig. 2.105 Placement of the spacer strips


The bracket that fix the batteries inside the battery tray has to be removed, before setup
of the battery set.
A second variant of the battery tray will be equipped with fixing plates to provide space
between the batteries. Proceed in accordance with the following figure:
Remove the MK:BATTERY from the battery tray before fitting of the batteries.
Mount the battery fixing plates at the bottom section of the battery tray.

MK:BATTERY

fixing plate

loosen the screws

Fig. 2.106 Preparation of the battery tray

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

111

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.7.3.1

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Installation of Backup Batteries Type Excide


Install and connect the backup batteries Excide (formerly Sonnenschein) in accordance with Fig. 2.107 and Fig. 2.108 in the following steps:
Switch OFF the circuit breaker at AC/DC 1-2 (BS-240 / 240 XL - Service1) and at
mounting kit battery (Service2).
Put on the battery 2 and 3 into the battery tray.
Connect the short cable with battery 2 (- terminal) and battery 3 (+ terminal).
Connect one of the long cables at battery 2 (+ terminal) and battery 3 (- terminal)
Move battery 2 and 3 as far as stop to the rear side of the battery tray.
Put on battery 1 and 4 into the tray.
Connect the long cable coming from battery 2 (+ terminal) at battery 1 (- terminal)
and the long cable coming from battery3 (- terminal) at battery 4 (+ terminal).
Connect the blue load-cable to battery 4 (- terminal) and the black load-cable and the
tempresistorcable to battery 1 (+ terminal).
Fasten the battery nuts to a torque of 20 Nm. Close and tighten both velcro straps.
Turn up the protection cap to the end position, during fasten the cables to the battery
terminals (avoid contact of metal).

WARNING
Only use insulated tools for connecting the cables to the battery terminals in order to
avoid accidental short circuits.

battery2

air vent tubes

battery 1

battery3

battery 4

velcro straps

Fig. 2.107 Battery tray with backup batteries type Excide

112

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

tempresistor cable
(color as shown not relevant)

- 48 V (blue)

+ 0 V (black)

+
2

4
+

+
air vent tube, routed via RF cable entry outside the rack

Fig. 2.108 Connection of backup battery set Excide


Setup the battery air vent system in accordance with the figure in steps as follows:
Setup a plastic angle (1) at the air outlet of each battery.
Fix one of the 4 clear plastic tubes (2) at each angle.
Connect the tubes of battery 2 and 3 with the T-connector (3).
Connect the tubes of battery 1 and 4 with cross-connector (4).
Setup the connection between the T-connector and the cross-connector. Use the
short plastic tube (5).
Connect the long clear plastic tube (6) at the cross-connector.
Equip the other end of the tube with the outlet nipple (7).
Route the tube along the right side rack frame upwards to the cable feeding module.
The outlet part will be placed inside the cable feeding module.
The tube must be fixed at the rack frame with cable ties.
The second T-connector (8) will be used for connecting the air vent system of a second
battery tray.

NOTE
In order to avoid the accumulation of hydrogen gas, please make sure to install the ventilation tube parts in a straight line and as short as possible, without any loops in vertical
direction.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

113

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

4
1

7
3
8

Fig. 2.109 Contents of the air vent kit Excide

2
1

5
4
6

1
8

Fig. 2.110 Assembly of the air vent kit Excide

114

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.7.3.2

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation of Backup Batteries Type Oerlicon


For installation of an Oerlicon battery set proceed in accordance with Fig. 2.111 and
Fig. 2.112 in steps as follows:
Switch off the circuit breaker at AC/DC 1-2 (BS-240 / 240 XL - Service1) or of ADP
(BS-240 II / 240 XL II - Service1A) and mounting kit battery (Service1A / Service2).
Put on the battery 1,2,3 and 4 into the battery tray.
Connect the + terminal of battery 1 and the - terminal of battery 2 with the short metal bridge.
Connect the following batteries in the same way.
Connect the blue load-cable to battery 1 (- terminal) and the black load-cable and
the temp-resistor cable to battery 4 (+ terminal).
Tighten the battery termination fixing screws to a torque with 6 Nm.
Tighten the cable termination fixing screws to a torque with 20 Nm.

NOTE
Turn up the protection cap to the end position, during tighten the cables to the battery
terminals (avoid contact of metal). The battery capacity must be adjusted at the AC/DC
(BS-240 / 240 XL) controller.

WARNING
Only use insulated tools for connecting the cables to the battery terminals in order to
avoid accidental short circuits.
After all electrical connections are complete, setup the air vent system:
Fix the short clear plastic tubes (1) at the air vent nipples of battery 2 and 3.
Fix the longer plastic tubes (2) at the air vent nipples of battery 1 and 4.
Connect the 4 tubes at the collector part (3).
Connect the long clear plastic tube (4) at the collector part.
Route the tube along the right side rack frame upwards through the cable feeding
module.
The tube must be fixed at the rack frame with cable ties.

NOTE
In order to avoid the accumulation of hydrogen gas, please make sure to install the ventilation tube parts in a straight line and as short as possible, without any loops in vertical
direction.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

115

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Temp-resistor cable

battery cable +0V

battery cable -48 V


1

air vent system

Fig. 2.111 Connection of backup batteries (Co. Oerlicon)

Fig. 2.112 Air vent system for Oerlicon battery set

116

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.7.3.3

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Install Backup Batteries Type EnerSys / Hawker


Before starting the installation of the battery sets switch OFF the circuit breaker at the
frame AC/DC 1-2 (BS-240 / 240 XL - Service1) or at the AD-panel (BS-240 II/240 XL II
- Service1A).

switch OFF

Fig. 2.113 Location of the Battery Breakers at the AD-Panel ADPAV3


Install and connect the EnerSys batteries (formerly Hawker) according to Fig. 2.114
and Fig. 2.118 as well as the following steps:
Place batteries 1,2,3 and 4 into the battery tray.
Mount the MK:BATTERY in its original position.
Connect the battery 1 (+ terminal) and battery 2 (- terminal) with the short metal
bridge and tighten the nuts with a torque of 5 Nm.
Connect the following batteries in the same way.
Fasten the accompanying protecting caps over the battery terminals.
Remove the protection cover of the MK:BATTERY.
Connect the blue load cable to battery 1 (- terminal) and connect the black load cable
and the temp-resistor cable to battery 4 (+ terminal).
Using a wrench set to a torque of 5 Nm, fasten the battery cable nuts.
Shift the protection caps of both battery cables to the end position to covering of the
battery poles.

bracket

Fig. 2.114 Placement and connection of the batteries

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

117

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

+ pole cable to MK:BATTERY

tempresistor cable

distance piece

metal bridge
battery 4

Fig. 2.115 Detail of the connection of battery 4

WARNING
Use only insulated tools to connect the cables to the battery nuts to avoid accidental
short circuits!
After all of the electrical connections are complete, install the air vent system of the battery set. It consist of 2,00 m plastic tube and 3 T-collectors. The plastic tube has to be
cutted into pieces with the length as shown in Fig. 2.116:

118

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

70 mm

4
100 mm
2
170 mm

Fig. 2.116 Parts of the air vent system

Fix the short clear plastic tubes (1) to the air vent connectors of batteries 2,3 and 4.
Fix the plastic tube (2) at the air vent connector of battery 1.
Connect the a T-collector part (3) at the tubes of battery 2,3 and 4.
Attach tube (2) of battery 1 to the T-collector of battery 2.
Connect the T-collectors of battery 2 - 3 and 3 - 4 with the 100 mm tubes (4).
Connect the pre-installed plastic tube that is routed to the gas outlet of the rack at
the T-collector of battery 4. Fix the tube at the rack frame with cable ties.
1

Fig. 2.117 Routing of the air vent tubes

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

119

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

The MK:BATTERY has to be connected with the DC input terminals of the AD-panel.
The pre-fabricated cables have to be attached to the + pole and the- pole of the
MK:BATTERY.Fix the cables at the mounting bars with cable ties as shown in the figure
below.
+

Fig. 2.118 Connection between the batteries, battery cable connection

120

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.7.4

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Inter-Rack Cable Routing (standard Configuration)


This chapter provides information about the cable connections from one rack to another,
dependent on the BS-240 / 240XL or BS-240 II / 240XL II rack types and configurations.

2.7.4.1

Battery Cabling of BS-240 / 240XL


An overview of the battery interrack cabling for BS-240 and BS-240XL is provided in the
tables below.
battery
system
BAT 0

BAT 1

BAT 2

BAT 3

Tab. 2.36

battery
cable no.

from

to

length

color

110/1

S1-AC/DC1-26b S1/BAT0/- (-48V)

1500 mm

blue

111/1

S1-AC/DC1-25b S1/BAT0/+ (+0V)

1500 mm

black

110/2

S1-AC/DC1-28b S2/1 BAT1 -1a

2850 mm

blue

111/2

S1-AC/DC1-27b S2/1 BAT1 -2a

2850 mm

black

110/3

S1-AC/DC2-15b S2/2 BAT2 -1a

3700 mm

blue

111/3

S1-AC/DC2-14b S2/2 BAT2 -2a

3700 mm

black

110/4

S1-AC/DC2-17b S2/3 BAT3 -1a

4200 mm

blue

111/4

S1-AC/DC2-16b S2/3 BAT3 -2a

4200 mm

black

List of battery cables between the racks (BS-240)

NOTE
Note: If the Service1 rack is equipped with two frames AC/DC (1 and 2) and only BAT0
and BAT1 should be connected to the AC/DC frames, connect BAT0 with F:AC/DC1
and BAT1 with F:AC/DC2.

battery
system
BAT 0

BAT 1

BAT 2

BAT 3

Tab. 2.37

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

battery
cable no.

from

to

length

color

110/1

S1-AC/DC1-20b S1/BAT0/- (-48V)

1750 mm

blue

111/1

S1-AC/DC1-19b S1/BAT0/+ (+0V)

1750 mm

black

110/2

S1-AC/DC1-22b S2/1 BAT1 -1a

3300 mm

blue

111/2

S1-AC/DC1-21b S2/1 BAT1 -2a

3300 mm

black

110/3

S1-AC/DC2-15b S2/2 BAT2 -1a

4200 mm

blue

111/3

S1-AC/DC2-14b S2/2 BAT2 -2a

4200 mm

black

110/4

S1-AC/DC2-17b S2/3 BAT3 -1a

4700 mm

blue

111/4

S1-AC/DC2-16b S2/3 BAT3 -2a

4700 mm

black

List of battery cables between the racks (BS-240XL)

121

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

battery
system

temp-resistor-cable
no.

from

to

length

BAT 0

112/1

S1/BAT0 (+)

S1/ AC/DC1 T0

2500 mm

BAT 1

112/2

S2/1 BAT1 (+)

S1/ AC/DC1 T1

2500 mm

BAT 2

112/3

S2/2 BAT2 (+)

S1/ AC/DC2 T0

5500 mm

BAT 3

112/4

S2/3 BAT3 (+)

S1/ AC/DC2 T1

5500 mm

Tab. 2.38

List of temp-resistor cables

a a a a

a a a a

25 26 27 28 T0

14 15 16 17 T0

b b b b

b b b b
T1

b c
-48 V
0V

1
2

terminal block battery frame

T1

+ - + BAT0 BAT1

+ - + BAT2 BAT3

terminal block
AC/DC1 frame

terminal block
AC/DC2 frame

Fig. 2.119 Terminal blocks for battery cables

Service 2/3
top cover

air vent

cable

112/3

110/3
111/3

air vent

air vent

air vent

temp-resistor

112/4

Service1

Service2/1

Service 2/2

112/2
110/2
111/2

frame AC/DC 1

110/1
111/1
T1

112/1

T0

frame AC/DC 2

110/4
111/4

BAT3

BAT2

T1

T0

BAT1

BAT0

Fig. 2.120 Overview of the battery cabling BS-240 / 240 XL

122

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.7.4.2

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Battery Cabling for BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADPAV3)


An overview of battery intra-/interrack cabling for BS-240 II and BS-240XL II with the AD
panel variant ADPAV3 is shown in the following table.

Cable
No

From

To
*1)

Color

Length
m

Factory No.
S30861-*

blue

1,50

X215-A70

black

1,70

blue

1,50

black

1,70

blue

2,71

418 /1

S1/A:MK: Battery 1

S1/A: ADP/BAT0 (-)

418 /2

S1/A:MK: Battery 1

S1/A: ADP/BAT0 (+)

418 /1

S1/A:MK: Battery 3

S1/A: ADP/BAT0 (-)

418 /2

S1/A:MK: Battery 3

S1/A: ADP/BAT0 (+)

419 /1

S1/A:MK: Battery 1

S1/A: ADP/BAT0 (-)

419 /2

S1/A:MK: Battery 1

S1/A: ADP/BAT0 (+)

black

2,71

422 /1

S2/1:MK: Battery 3

S1/A: MK: Battery 1 or 2

blue

1,71

422 /2

S2/1:MK: Battery 3

S1/A: MK: Battery 1 or 2

black

1,71

422 /1

S2/2:MK: Battery 3

S2/1: MK: Battery 1, 2 or 3

blue

1,71

422 /2

S2/2:MK: Battery 3

S2/1: MK: Battery 1, 2 or 3

black

1,71

422 /1

S2/3:MK: Battery 1, 2 or 3

S1/2: MK: Battery 3

blue

1,71

422 /2

S2/3:MK: Battery 1, 2 or 3

S1/2: MK: Battery 3

black

1,71

423 /1

S2/1:MK: Battery 1 or 2

S1/A: MK: Battery 1

blue

3,00

423 /2

S2/1:MK: Battery 1 or 2

S1/A: MK: Battery 1

black

3,00

423 /1

S2/2:MK: Battery 1 or 2

S2/1: MK: Battery 1

blue

3,00

423 /2

S2/2:MK: Battery 1 or 2

S2/1: MK: Battery 1

black

3,00

423 /1

S2/1:XL MK: Battery 1, 2 or 3

S1/A: XL: MK: Battery 1

blue

3,00

423 /2

S2/1:XL MK: Battery 1, 2 or 3

S1/A: XL: MK: Battery 1

black

3,00

140 / 1 MK: Battery 1

MK: Battery 2

blue

1,00

140 / 2 MK: Battery 1

MK: Battery 2

black

0,60

140 / 1 MK: Battery 2

MK: Battery 3

blue

1,00

140 / 2 MK: Battery 2

MK: Battery 3

black

0,60

141 / 1 F: Battery - 48V

MK: Battery (2b)

blue

0,60

141 / 2 F: Battery 0V

MK: Battery (1a)

black

0,40

*1)

*1)

*2)

X215-A70

X215-A71

X215-A74

X215-A74

X215-A74

X215-A76

X215-A76

X215-A76

X216-A74

X216-A74

*1) If required, adapt or shorten the cable length


*2) Only in case of XL-Rack: use the longer cable 423 instead the cable 422.
Tab. 2.39

List of battery cables between the racks of BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A with ADPAV3)

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

123

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Cable Signal Name


No
53

BATT TEMP

From

To

Factory No.
S30864-*

F:AC/DC / CTRL / X11 F:Battery, +POL,


(+0V) *1)

X216-A92

*1) Connect the battery sensor to the upper Service1- battery. If there is no battery
installed, connect the sensor to the upper battery of Service2 rack.
Tab. 2.40

Battery sensor cabling

WARNING
Short circuit risk! For fastening of DC supply connections at the AD panel connectors,
use only an insulated hexagonal screw key/ratchet (M6).
Service 1

Service 2/1

AC/DC frame

6 x HU for LE 0 - 5
AD panel

160A

LE panel

140

BAT

422

418
6 x HU for LE 0 - 5

141

160A

160A

Battery 3

141

141

140

140

160A

160A

Battery 2

Battery 2

141
Battery 1

141
Battery 1

Fig. 2.121 Example of battery cabling of BS-240XL II (S1A, ADPAV3)

124

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Service2/3

Service2/2
LE panel (S2)
422

Service1/A

LE panel (S2)

423

422

160A

LE panel (S2)

Service2/1

AC/DC frame

HU for LE 0 - 5
or

140

Battery 3

141

AD panel

1)

LE panel
(S1/A)

418

BAT

160A

160A

160A

Battery 3

140

HU for LE 0 - 5

141
Battery 2

160A

Battery 2
160A

Battery 2

141

160A

140

140

160A

141

141

141

Battery 1

141

Battery 1

141
Battery 1

Battery 1

Fig. 2.122 Example of battery cabling of BS-240 II (S1A, ADPAV3)

from AC/DC system


0V -48V
to subsequent Service2 cabinet

BAT / -48V

160A

1)

AD panel (ADP)
+
MK:BATTERY 2)

+
BAT / -48V

MK:BATTERY 2)

BAT / -48V

160A

set of batteries in Service1A

1)

180A

160A

Service2

set of batteries in

MK:BATTERY 2)

BAT / -48V

MK:BATTERY 2)

BR 33

160A

1)

1) battery breaker alarm line to ACTC


2) MK:BATTERY is integral part of
F:BARTTERY

1)

Fig. 2.123 Overview of battery breakers in S1A / S2

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

125

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.7.4.3

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Battery Cabling for BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADP-2V1)


The battery intra-/interrack cabling for BS-240 II and BS-240XL II with AD panel variant
ADP-2V1 is shown in the following table.

Cable
No

From

To

518 /1

S1A:MK: Battery 1 or2

S1A: ADP/BAT (-)

518 /2

S1A:MK: Battery 1 or 2

S1A: ADP/BAT (+)

519 /1

S2/1:MK: Battery 1, 2 or 3

S1A: ADP/BAT (-)

519 /2

S2/1:MK: Battery 1, 2 or 3

S1A: ADP/BAT (+)

522 /1

S2/1:MK: Battery 3

S1A: MK: Battery 1 or 2

522 /2

S2/1:MK: Battery 3

S1A: MK: Battery 1 or 2

522 /1

S2/2:MK: Battery 3

S2/1: MK: Battery 1, 2 or 3

522 /2

S2/2:MK: Battery 3

S2/1: MK: Battery 1, 2 or 3

522 /1

S2/3:MK: Battery 1, 2 or 3

S2/2: MK: Battery 3

522 /2

S2/3:MK: Battery 1, 2 or 3

S2/2: MK: Battery 3

523 /1

S2/1:MK: Battery 1, 2 or 3

S1A: MK: Battery 1 or 2

523 /2

S2/1:MK: Battery 1, 2 or 3

S1A: MK: Battery 1 or 2

523 /1

S2/2:MK: Battery 1, 2 or 3

S2/1: MK: Battery 1

523 /2

S2/2:MK: Battery 1, 2 or 3

S2/1: MK: Battery 1

540 / 1 MK: Battery 1

MK: Battery 2

540 / 2 MK: Battery 1

MK: Battery 2

540 / 1 MK: Battery 2

MK: Battery 3

540 / 2 MK: Battery 2

MK: Battery 3

541 / 1 F: Battery - 48V

MK: Battery (2b)

541 / 2 F: Battery 0V

MK: Battery (1a)

Color Length Factory No.


m
S30861-*
240;
240XL

blue

1.90

black

2.10

240;
240XL

blue

3.10

black

3.30

240;
240XL

blue

2.60

black

2.40

240;
240XL

blue

2.60

black

2.40

240;
240XL

blue

2.60

black

2.40

240;
240XL

blue

3.00

black

2.70

240

blue

3.00

black

2.70

blue

0.55

black

0.55

240;
240XL

blue

0.55

black

0.55

240;
240XL

blue

0.265

black

0.275

240;
240XL

X215-A190

X215-A191

X215-A159

X215-A159

X215-A159

X215-A160

X215-A160

X215-A158

X215-A158

*1)

*1) only for battery pole with tapped hole M8: S30864-X215-A161; only for battery pole with tapped hole M10:
S30864-X215-A162
Tab. 2.41

126

Battery cables between the racks of BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADP-2V1)

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Cable Signal Name


No
53

From

BATT TEMP

To

Factory No.
S30864-*

F:AC/DC / CTRL / X11 F:Battery, +POL,


(+0V) *1)

X216-A92

*1) Connect the battery sensor to the upper Service1- battery. If there is no battery
installed, connect the sensor to the upper battery of Service2 rack.
Tab. 2.42

Battery sensor cabling

WARNING

Short circuit risk! For fastening of DC supply connections at the AD panel connectors,
use only an insulated hexagonal screw key/ratchet (M6).

Service2/3

Service2/2
LE panel (S2)

522

FAN#0

FAN#0

FAN#1

FAN#1

522

*1)

HU for LE 0 - 5
or

540
540

Service1/A

LE panel (S2)
160A

LE panel (S2)

Service2/1

523

Battery 3

541

160A

160A

160A

Battery 3

540

541

540

541

540

Battery 2

160A

HU for LE 0 - 5

Battery 2

160A

Battery 2

541

518

160A

540

540

160A

540

541

541

Battery 1

541

Battery 1

Battery 1

141
Battery 1

*1)
E2
E1
B
Batt

518-1 or 519-1
518-2 or
519-2

If the cables 518 1/2 or 519 1/2


should be used to connect the
MK: Battery with a Service1A
Rack, equipped with AD-panel ADPAV3,
cut off the connectors and remove 24 mm of
the insulation.

Fig. 2.124 Example of battery cabling of BS-240 II (S1A, ADP-2V1)

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

127

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Service 1

Service 2/1

FAN#0

FAN#0

FAN#1

FAN#1

*1)

160A

6 x HU for LE 0 - 5

522

540
540

518
6 x HU for LE 0 - 5

541

160A

160A

Battery 3

540
541

541

540

540

540

Battery 2

160A

160A

Battery 2

541

541

Battery 1

Battery 1

*1)
E2
E1
B
Batt

518-1 or 519-1
518-2 or 519-2

If the cables 518 1/2 or 519 1/2


should be used to connect the
MK:Battery with a Service1A Rack,
equipped with AD-panel ADPAV3,
cut off the connectors and remove 24 mm of
the insulation.

Fig. 2.125 Example of battery cabling of BS-240XL II (S1A, ADP-2V1)

128

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.7.4.4

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Battery Alarm Cable Connections


The cable connections of the battery breaker alarm is shown in the circuit diagram below. The alarm terminals of each MK:Battery within a service rack will be connected in
series to lead them to the alarm-terminal of the ACTC.

Service1A

Service2/n
ACTC

DCP:LEBREAK2
or ADPA/F:ACTC

FAN#0

FAN#1

462
MK:BATTERY
C NO NC
A
160 A

1c 1b1a

463
BAT / -48 V

462
MK:BATTERY

MK:BATTERY
C NO NC
A
160 A

C NO NC

1c 1b1a

160 A

1c 1b1a

463
BAT / -48 V

BAT / -48 V

463

MK:BATTERY

MK:BATTERY
C NO NC
A
160 A

C NO NC

1c 1b1a

160 A

BAT / -48 V

BAT / -48 V

462
1c 1b1a

Cable 462: S30864-X211-A173 (Set: 2 x 462)


Cable 463: S30864-X211-A174
Fig. 2.126 Battery alarm cables

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

129

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.7.4.5

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

DC Cabling between the Racks (BS-240 / 240XL)


The DC cabling is required for routing of the -48V voltage from the DC panel of Service1
rack to the DC panels of all installed racks on site for power supply of the boards in Base
and Extension racks and the link equipment inside the Service racks.

Fig. 2.127 Routing of the DC power supply wires

+0 V

-48 V

unscrew

DC supply wires
Fig. 2.128 DC terminal block access of BS-240 / 240XL

Service2 Rack
DC-Panel

Service1 Rack
DC-Panel 34 1)

Base Rack
DC-Panel

35 1)

DC-Panel

Extension2 Rack
DC-Panel
terminal block

33 1)
279 2)

Extension1 Rack

36 1)

1) Component of MK: CARSV1


2) S30864-X211-A69

Fig. 2.129 Routing of DC cabling between the BS-240 racks

130

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

cable no.

polarity

from DC-Panel
Service1 Rack

to rack

color

33

0V
-48 V

13b
14b

Service 2 / 5b
Service 2 / 2b

black
blue

34

0V
-48 V

11b
12b

Base / 9b
Base / 4b

black
blue

35

0V
-48 V

9b
10b

Extension 1 / 9b
Extension 1 / 4b

black
blue

36

0V
-48 V

7b
8b

Extension 2 / 9b
Extension 2 / 4b

black
blue

DC- Cabling to further Service2/x


cable no.

polarity

from DC-Panel
Service2/x Rack

to DC-Panel
Service2/x+1 Rack

color

279

0V
-48 V

5a
2a

5b
2b

black
blue

Tab. 2.43

List of DC cable connections between BS-240 racks

Service2 Rack

Base Rack

Service1 Rack

DC-Panel

DC-Panel 34 1)

DC-Panel

Extension1 Rack

35 1)

DC-Panel

33 1)

279 2)

1) Component of MK: CARSV1 2) S30864-X211-A69


Fig. 2.130 Routing of DC cabling between BS-240XL racks

cable no.

polarity

from DC-Panel
Service1 Rack

to rack

color

33

0V
-48 V

11b
12b

Service2 / 5b
Service2 / 2b

black
blue

34

0V
-48 V

9b
10b

Base / 10b
Base / 5b

black
blue

35

0V
-48 V

7b
8b

Extension1 / 8b
Extension1 / 4b

black
blue

DC- Cabling to further Service2/x


cable no.

polarity

from DC-Panel
Service2/x Rack

to DC-Panel
Service2/x+1 Rack

color

279

0V
-48 V

5a
2a

5b
2b

black
blue

Tab. 2.44

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

DC cable connections between the BS-240XL racks

131

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.7.4.6

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

DC Connections BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADPAV3)


The figure below shows the DC power distribution from rack Service1A, AD panel
ADPAV3 to the Base and Extension racks (DC panel) of BS-240 II / 240XL II.

Service1A
FAN0

Base

FAN1

0V
-48V

ACTC

LE
+-

FAN0

ACTC

0V
-48V
BR01BR02BR03 BR04BR05 BR06

FAN1

DC panel

FAN0

FAN1

180A

BE1E2 BE1E2

- - -

DC panel

AD-Panel ADPAV3

ACTC

X29

BR01BR02BR03 BR04BR05 BR06

FAN11

FAN0

ACTC

0V
-48V

BR01BR02BR03 BR04BR05 BR06BR07BR08

AC/DC

Extension2 415

Extension1 414

413

BR 33

+++

BAT
01

+-

Service Socket

413
414
415

Fig. 2.131 DC cabling between the BS-240 II / 240 XL II racks (S1A, ADPAV3)

WARNING
Short circuit risk! For fastening of all DC supply connections at the connectors, use
only an insulated hexagonal screw key/ratchet (M6).

cable
no.

polarity

from

to rack

color

413/1

-48V

S1/A:ADP:B

Base

blue

413/2

0V

S1/A:ADP:B

Base

black

414/1

-48V

S1/A:ADP:E1

Extension1

blue

414/2

0V

S1/A:ADP:E1

Extension1

black

415/1

-48V

S1/A:ADP:E2

Extension2

blue

415/2

0V

S1/A:ADP:E2

Extension2

black

Tab. 2.45

FactoryNo.
S30864-*

Length
m

X215-A56 1,50

X215-A57 2,20

X215-A58 2,80

DC cable connections between BS-240 II / 240XL II racks (S1A, ADPAV3)

Optional: The Base and Extension racks can be also connected to an external DC power
supply via an own rack-internal MSU:DC, located at the EMI panel. In this case a
Service1 / Service1A rack is not necessary.

132

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.7.4.7

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

-48V DC Connections BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADP-2V1)


The following figure shows the DC power distribution from rack Service1A, AD panel
ADP-2V1 to the Base and Extension racks (DC panel) of the BS-240 II / 240XL II.

AD-Panel ADP-2V1
FAN#0

DC-Panel

DC-Panel

DC-Panel

FAN#1
FAN#0

COBA 0
COSA 0
COBA 1
COSA 1

CU CU
#0 #1

FAN#0

FAN#1

FAN#2

CU
#4

FAN#1

CU CU
#0 #1

CU
#5

CU
#4

FAN#2

FAN#3

515-1

E2

514-1

E1

513-1

515-2
514-2
513-2

Batt

CU
#5

FAN#1

CU CU
#0 #1

FAN#3

513-2
513-1

DCP:LEBREAK

FAN#0

CU
#4

FAN#2

514-2
514-1

CU
#5

FAN#3

515-2
515-1

If the cables 513 - 515 1/2


should be used to connect the
Base- and Extension Racks with a Service1A
Rack, equipped with AD-panel ADPAV3,
cut off the connectors and remove 24 mm of
the insulation.

Fig. 2.132 DC cabling between the BS-240 II / 240 XL II racks (S1A, ADP-2V1)

WARNING
Short circuit risk! For fastening of all DC supply connections at the connectors, use
only an insulated hexagonal screw key/ratchet (M6).

cable
no.

polarity

from

to rack

color

513/1

-48V

S1/A:ADP:B

Base

blue

513/2

0V

S1/A:ADP:B

Base

black

514/1

-48V

S1/A:ADP:E1

Extension1

blue

514/2

0V

S1/A:ADP:E1

Extension1

black

515/1

-48V

S1/A:ADP:E2

Extension2

blue

515/2

0V

S1/A:ADP:E2

Extension2

black

Tab. 2.46

FactoryNo.
S30864-*
X215-A192

Length
m
1,15
1,10

X215-A193

1,75
1,70

X215-A194

2,35
2,30

DC cable connections between BS-240 II / 240XL II racks (S1A, ADP-2V1)

Optional: The Base and Extension racks can be also connected to an external DC power
supply via an own rack-internal MSU:DC, located at the EMI panel. In this case a
Service1 / Service1A rack is not necessary.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

133

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.7.4.8

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

-48 V DC for Link Equipment of BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADPAV3)


The DC Link Equipment Panel provides the distribution of the -48 V supply voltage to
the modules within the BS-240 II / 240XL II Service2 racks. The clamp terminals for connecting the DC supply wires are located on the front of the panel. A routing example of
DC cables is shown in the following sketch. The cable types for possible configurations
are listed in Tab. 2.47. If link equipment is installed in the Service1A and Service2 racks,
the associated DC:LE panel must be equipped with an appropriate number of breakers.
The LE breakers can be plugged-in during the installation of link equipment.

Service2/3

Service2/2

0V-48V
+ -

DCP:LEBREAK2

X10

0V-48V

0V-48V

ACTC

DCP:LEBREAK2

+ -

X10

Service1A

Service2/1

ACTC

DCP:LEBREAK2

+ -

X10

FAN0

ACTC

FAN1

AC/DC frame
403
2)

406

406

403
1)
LE

403
4)

403
3)

DCP:LEBREAK

X29

+-

0V -48V
+ + - -

ACTC

AD Panel

ACTC
X10

180A

BE1E2

BE1E2 BR 33

BAT
01

- - -

+++

+-

Service Socket

0V -48V

LE breaker

+ + - - X10

402

2): if Service1A without DC panel: LEBREAK and Link Equipment


3), 4): if Service 2/1 with additional second DC panel: LEBREAK and Link Equipment
for 1), 2), 3) and 4) see also table below

Fig. 2.133 DC cabling for link equipment of BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADPAV3)

cable
no.
402

polarity

to rack

color

-48 V

S1/A:ADP:x29:1

S1/A:DCP:LEBREAK:x10:3

blue

0V

S1/A:ADP:x29:2

S1/A:DCP:LEBREAK:x10:1

black

403, 1) -48 V
0V
403, 2) -48 V
0V
403, 3) -48 V
0V
403, 4) -48 V
0V
Tab. 2.47

134

from

S2/1:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:2 S1/A:DCP:LEBREAK:x10:4

blue

S2/1:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:1 S1/A:DCP:LEBREAK:x10:2

black

S2/1:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:2 S1/A:ADP:x29:1

blue

S2/1:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:1 S1/A:ADP:x29:2

black

S2/1:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:2 S2/1:DCP:LEBREAK:x10:3

blue

S2/1:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:1 S2/1:DCP:LEBREAK:x10:1

black

S2/1:DCP:LEBREAK:x10:4

S2/2:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:2

blue

S2/1:DCP:LEBREAK:x10:2

S2/2:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:1

black

FactoryNo.
S30864-*

Length
m

X215-A40 1,20

X215-A41 1,20

X215-A41 1,20

X215-A41 1,20

X215-A41 1,20

Cables for link equipment of BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADPAV3)

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

cable
no.
406

406

polarity

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

from

to rack

color

-48 V

S2/2:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:2 S2/1:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:2

blue

0V

S2/2:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:1 S2/1:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:1

black

-48 V

S2/3:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:2 S2/2:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:2

blue

0V

S2/3:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:1 S2/2:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:1

black

Tab. 2.47

FactoryNo.
S30864-*

Length
m

X215-A80 0,80

X215-A80 0,80

Cables for link equipment of BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADPAV3)

2.7.4.9

-48 V DC for Link Equipment of BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADP-2V1)


The DC Link Equipment Panel provides the distribution of the -48 V supply voltage to
the modules within the BS-240 II / 240XL II Service2 racks. The clamp terminals for connecting the DC supply wires are located on the front of the panel. A routing example of
DC cables is shown in the following sketch. The cable types for possible configurations
are listed in Tab. 2.48. If link equipment is installed in the Service1A and Service2 racks,
the associated DC:LE panel must be equipped with an appropriate number of breakers.
The LE breakers can be plugged-in during the installation of link equipment.
F:ACTC

DCP:LEBREAK

FAN#0
FAN#0

FAN#1

FAN#0

AD-Panel
FAN#1
FAN#0

FAN#1

HU # 0 for LE

HU # 1 for LE

HU # 1 for LE

HU # 2 for LE

HU # 2 for LE

HU # 3 for LE

HU # 3 for LE

HU # 4 for LE

HU # 4 for LE

HU # 5 for LE

HU # 5 for LE

CU CU
#0 #1

FAN#1

FAN#2

CU
#4

CU
#5

FAN#3

160A

160A

HU # 0 for LE

DC-Panel

COBA 0
COSA 0
COBA 1
COSA 1

DCP:LEBREAK2

with LE in Service1A
402

X10

X10
33/M

Service2 Rack

X29

DCP:LEBREAK
X10

503
Service2 Rack

Service1A Rack

Base Rack

Fig. 2.134 DC cabling for link equipment of BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADP-2V1)

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

135

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

F:ACTC

DCP:LEBREAK

FAN#0
FAN#1

FAN#0

DC-Panel

FAN#1
FAN#0

FAN#1

HU # 0 for LE

HU # 1 for LE

HU # 1 for LE

HU # 2 for LE

HU # 2 for LE

HU # 3 for LE

HU # 3 for LE

HU # 4 for LE

HU # 4 for LE

HU # 5 for LE

HU # 5 for LE

CU CU
#0 #1

FAN#2
160A

160A

HU # 0 for LE

FAN#1

CU
#4

CU
#5

FAN#3

160A

FAN#0

AD-Panel

COBA 0
COSA 0
COBA 1
COSA 1

DCP:LEBREAK2

without LE in Service1A

X10

X10
33/M

Service2 Rack

X29
503

Service2 Rack

Base Rack

Service1A Rack

Fig. 2.135 DC cabling for link equipment of BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADP-2V1)

cable
no.
402

503

33/M

33/M

polarity

to rack

color

-48 V

S1/A:ADP:x29:1

S1/A:DCP:LEBREAK:x10:2

blue

0V

S1/A:ADP:x29:2

S1/A:DCP:LEBREAK:x10:1

black

-48 V

S2/1:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:2 S1/A:DCP:LEBREAK:x10:2

blue

0V

S2/1:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:1 S1/A:DCP:LEBREAK:x10:1

black

-48 V

S2/1:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:2 S2/2:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:2

blue

0V

S2/1:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:1 S2/2:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:1

black

-48 V

S2/2:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:2 S2/3:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:2

blue

0V

S2/2:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:1 S2/3:DCP:LEBREAK2:x10:1

black

Tab. 2.48

136

from

FactoryNo.
S30864-*

Length
m

X215-A40 1,20

X215A164

1,30

X211A152

0,90

X211A152

0,90

DC cabling for link equipment of BS-240 II / 240XL II (S1A, ADP-2V1)

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.7.4.10

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

CAN-Bus Connections
The CAN-Bus will be routed in loop configuration through the racks to collect external
and internal alarms and lead them to the ACT of the Base rack.
The configuration rules for CAN-Bus connections are valid for BS-240 / BS-240XL and
BS-240 II / 240XL II rack types.
The assignment of the cable length to the rack configuration is dependent on the mounting sequence. The CAN-Bus must be terminated at the end (CAN OUT) with the terminating resistor S30861-K2047-K. This measure is mandatory.
The Rack inter-connection for CAN-bus cable is from Rack top to Rack top and guided
inside the Rack roof/cover area.
The Tab. 2.49 and the Fig. 2.137 show an example of CAN-Bus connections.
cable no.

from CAN OUT

to CAN IN

Code no.

length

245

Base

Service1

S30864-X210-A11

1200 mm

246

Service1/ Service1A

Extension1

S30864-X210-A12

1900 mm

247

Extension1

Service2/1

S30864-X210-A13

2600 mm

248

Service2/1

Extension2

S30864-X210-A14

3300 mm

249

Extension2

Service2/2

S30864-X210-A15

4000 mm

S30864-X210-A60

6800 mm

S30864-X210-A61

7800 mm

S30864-X210-A63

5000 mm

S30864-X210-A66

12000 mm

Cables for configurations with distance between


the cabinets

Tab. 2.49

Example for CAN-Bus cabling

N
CA

IN

or

t
sis

g
tin

OU

ST

CA

re

TE

CA

in

m
er

Fig. 2.136 Location of CAN-Bus interfaces

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

137

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

EMI-P: RS
CAN IN

EMI-P: RE

EMI-P: RB

- 48 V

CAN IN

CAN IN

- 48 V

- 48 V

CAN OUT SERIAL IF

CAN OUT SERIAL IF

CAN OUT SERIAL IF

CAN TEST LPA

CAN TEST LPA

CAN TEST LPA

terminating
resistor
rear side of racks

246
247

245
248
249
(for BS-240/-240II only)

Service2/2

Service2/1

Service1

Extension1

Base

Extension2

front side of racks

Fig. 2.137 Example for CAN-Bus cable connections

2.7.4.11

SELIC-Cabling between the Racks


The SELIC-cabling (CC-link) provides a connection between the core modules in the
Base rack and the carrier units in the Extension racks.These connections are absolute
required for transmission of signalling and alarms between the racks. The interfaces are
located on the EMI panel of Base- and Extension racks.
In a standard configuration the same type of racks will be connected only. For each connection (Base to Extension1/2), prefabricated cables are provided. These cables
(S30864-X210-A2, -A23, -A38) are component of the relevant Extension racks.

Ext. 1 CU 4...7
Ext. 1 CU 0...3
Ext. 2 CU 4...7
Ext. 2 CU 0...3

Fig. 2.138 Location of SELIC interfaces (BS-240)

138

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Ext.1 CU 4...7

CU 4...7

CU 4...7

Ext.1 CU 0...3

CU 0...3

CU 0...3

(Ext.2) CU 4...7
(Ext.2) CU 0...3

277
278

Extension 1 Rack

Base Rack

Extension 2 Rack

Fig. 2.139 SELIC-cabling between the racks BS-240 / 240 II

Racktype
BS-240

Cable From interface


no.
Base Rack

To interface Extension Rack

Factory
No.:
S30864-*

277

Ext. 1 CU 0...3

Extension 1 CU 0...3

X210-A2

Ext. 1 CU 4...7

Extension 1 CU 4...7

Ext. 2 CU 0...3

Extension 2 CU 0...3

Ext. 2 CU 4...7

Extension 2 CU 4...7

278

Tab. 2.50

Racktype
BS-240 II

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

1975 mm

List of SELIC-cabling BS-240

Cable From interface


no.
Base Rack

To interface Extension Rack

Factory
No.:
S30864-*

Cable
length

277

Ext. 1 CU 0...3

Extension 1 CU 0...3

X210-A38

1920 mm

Ext. 1 CU 4...7

Extension 1 CU 4...7

Ext. 2 CU 0...3

Extension 2 CU 0...3

Ext. 2 CU 4...7

Extension 2 CU 4...7

278

Tab. 2.51

Cable
length

List of SELIC-cabling BS-240 II

139

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Ext. 1 CU 8..11
Ext. 1 CU 4...7
Ext. 1 CU 0...3

Fig. 2.140 Location of SELIC interfaces (BS-240XL)

Ext.1 CU 8...11

Ext.1 CU 8...11

Ext.1 CU 4...7

Ext.1 CU 4...7

Ext.1 CU 0...3

Ext.1 CU 0...3

330

Base Rack

162

161

Extension 1 Rack

Fig. 2.141 SELIC-cabling of BS-240XL / 240XL II

Rack type

BS-240XL

To interface Extension Rack

161

Ext.1 CU 0...3

Extension1 CU 0...3

162

Ext.1 CU 4...7

Extension1 CU 4...7

330

Ext.1 CU 8...11

Extension1 CU 8...11

BS-240XL II 161

Ext.1 CU 0...3

Extension1 CU 0...3

162

Ext.1 CU 4...7

Extension1 CU 4...7

330

Ext.1 CU 8...11

Extension1 CU 8...11

Tab. 2.52

140

Cable From interface


No.
Base Rack

Factory
No.:
S30864-*

Cable
length

X210-A23

915 mm

X210-A23

915 mm

SELIC-cabling of BS-240XL and BS-240XL II

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.7.5

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Inter-Rack Cabling (mixed Configuration)


This chapter provides information about the cable connections between racks, dependent on the rack type and equipping variant (BS-240 / 240XL with BS-240 II / 240XL II).
Inter-rack cables are not pre-installed in the factory and foreseen for setup on site.
The required distances rack rear to wall must be considered. The required minimum distances for the rack variants are listed in Fig. 2.20. In case of mixed configuration, the
BS-240 racks have be shifted 50 mm away from the wall, to allow the rack interconnection of both rack types.
The -48V DC cable connection between the racks will be routed through the cut-outs at
the side walls of the racks.
The power cables of the BS-240 cabinets are routed behind the DC-Panel cover and the
power cable of the BS-240 II cabinets are routed visible in front of the DC-Panel.
If racks have to be fixed to the floor with earthquake kits, the relevant minimum distance
to the wall is 150 mm.
The covered cut-outs plates at the sides of the rack and the break-out pieces of the top
covers of first and second generation are not corresponding. Therefore the rack interconnections for SELIC-, CAN-Bus- and EMC/grounding have to be routed through removed break-out pieces at the rear of the racks top covers (see Fig. 2.142).

Cover

Cover

Cables: e.g. CAN-Bus


SELIC
EMC-cable

2. Generation

1. Generation

View of rear side

Fig. 2.142 Adaptation of the top cover for interrack cable routing

NOTE
According to the relevant EMC requirements, the top cover of the rack have to be
mounted always!

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

141

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.7.5.1

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Battery Cabling between BS-240 and BS-240 II Racks


The battery backup time of already installed BS-240 racks can be extended with additional battery sets inside of BS-240 II racks. In addition to the battery kits that will used
for connections between the battery sets and connection of the battery sets with the
AC/DC frames (BS-240) or with the AD-Panel (BS-240 II), cable kits are provided for the
connection of BS-240 II Service2 racks with the AC/DC frames in the BS-240 Service1
rack.

SIEMENS

SIEMENS

110/3M

0V -48V

0V -48V

ACTC

111/3M

ACTC

LE Panel (S2)

to S2/3

LE Panel (S2)

FAN#0

from S1

FAN#1

FAN#0

FAN#1

110/4M
111/4M

160A

160A

FAN#0

FAN#1

LE-Panel

BAT2

F:AC/DC 1
111/2

111/1

110/2

110/1

FAN#0

FAN#1

166

BAT3

FAN#1

HU # 0 for LE 110/2
HU # 1 for LE
HU # 2 for LE 111/2
HU # 3 for LE
HU # 4 for LE
HU # 5 for LE

160A

FAN#0

Service1

Service2/1

Service2/2

Service2/3

111/4M

181

182

BAT2

111/3M
110/3M

168

BAT1

F:AC/DC 2

160A

160A

110/4M

166

166
168

168

BAT0

BAT3

BAT2

BAT1

BS-240 II Rack

BS-240 II Rack

BS-240 Rack

F:AC/DC 1

F:AC/DC 2

112/3

112/1

a a a a

a a a a

T0

25 26 27 28

112/2

b b b b

BS-240 Rack

T0

14 15 16 17

112/4

b b b b
T1

T1
+ - + -

+ - + -

BAT 0 BAT 1

BAT 2 BAT 3

Fig. 2.143 Example of Battery Cabling with BS-240 and BS-240 II Service Racks

142

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Cable no.

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

From

To

Factory no.

length

Color

110/1/M
111/1/M

S1/F:AC/DC1-26b
S1/F:AC/DC1-25b

S1 BAT0 with MK:BAT (-)


S1 BAT0 with MK:BAT (+)

S30864X211-A146

1300 mm

blue
black

110/2/M
111/2/M

S1/F:AC/DC1-28b
S1/F:AC/DC1-27b

S2/1 BAT1 MK:BAT (-)


S2/1 BAT1 MK:BAT (+)

S30864X211-A147

3300 mm

blue
black

110/3/M
111/3/M

S1/F:AC/DC2-15b
S1/F:AC/DC2-14b

S2/2 BAT2 MK:BAT (-)


S2/2 BAT2 MK:BAT (+)

S30864X211-A148

3700 mm

blue
black

110/4/M
111/4/M

S1/F:AC/DC2-17b
S1/F:AC/DC2-16b

S2/3 BAT3 MK:BAT (-)


S2/3 BAT3 MK:BAT (+)

S30864X211-A149

4600 mm

blue
black

Tab. 2.53

Battery Cable Kits for Connection BS-240 with BS-240 II S2 Racks

Cable no.

from

to

Factory no.

length

112/1

Service1, BAT 0 (+)

Service1 AC/DC 1, T 0

S30864-X210-A51

2500 mm

112/2

Service2/1, BAT 1 (+)

Service1 AC/DC 1, T 1

S30864-X210-A51

2500 mm

112/3

Service2/2, BAT 2 (+)

Service1 AC/DC 2, T 0

S30864-X210-A52

5500 mm

112/4

Service2/3, BAT 3 (+)

Service1 AC/DC 2, T 1

S30864-X210-A52

5500 mm

Tab. 2.54

Overview of the Tempresistor Cables

NOTE
The terminal clamps of MK:BATTERYV1/...V2 (with 50A breaker) have a maximum current rating of 75 Ampere.
If the 50A rating of each battery set is not sufficient for the relevant BTS configuration,
the following changes are necessary in service racks of first generation:
Replacement of each MK:BATTERYV1/...V2 (50A) by a MK:BATTERYV4 (160A).
Replacement of the old battery cabling by the standard battery cable set for the second generation. Exception: for the connection of booth poles of each battery set of
the relevant MK:BATTERYV4, the specific cable pair (S30864-X216-A75) must be
implemented.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

143

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.7.5.2

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Battery Cabling between BS-240XL and BS-240XL II Racks


The battery backup time of already installed BS-240XL racks can be extended with additional battery sets inside of BS-240XL II racks. In addition to the battery kits that will
used for connections between the battery sets and connection of the battery sets with
the AC/DC frames (BS-240XL) or with the AD-Panel (BS-240XL II), cable kits are provided for the connection of BS-240XL II Service2 racks with the AC/DC frames in the
BS-240XL Service1 rack.

Service2/2 Rack

Service1

Service2/1 Rack

SIEMENS

SIEMENS
0V -48V

0V -48V

ACTC

ACTC

LE Panel (S2)

LE Panel (S2)

FAN#0
FAN#0

FAN#0

FAN#1

HU # 0 for LE
HU # 1 for LE
HU # 2 for LE
HU # 3 for LE
HU # 4 for LE
HU # 5 for LE

FAN#0

F:AC/DC 1
111/2

FAN#1

110/1

FAN#0

FAN#1

111/3M

to
S2/2

110/3M

to
S2/3

110/4M

111/4M

F:AC/DC 2

160A

160A

111/1

110/2

HU # 0 for LE
HU # 1 for LE
HU # 2 for LE
HU # 3 for LE
HU # 4 for LE
HU # 5 for LE

from
S1

FAN#1

FAN#1

168

160A

160A

166

168

BAT1

BAT 0

second Generation

first Generation

BAT2

second Generation

166

F:AC/DC 1

F:AC/DC 2

112/3

112/1

a a a a

a a a a

T0

25 26 27 28

112/2

b b b b

T0

14 15 16 17

112/4

b b b b
T1

T1
+ - + -

+ - + -

BAT 0 BAT 1

BAT 2 BAT 3

Fig. 2.144 Example of Battery Cabling BS-240XL / S1 and BS-240XL II / S2

144

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Cable no.

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

From

To

Factory no.

length

Color

110/1
111/1

S1/F:AC/DC1-26b
S1/F:AC/DC1-25b

S1 BAT0 (-)
S1 BAT0 (+)

S30864-X211A33

1750 mm

blue
black

110/1/M
111/1/M

S1/F:AC/DC1-26b
S1/F:AC/DC1-25b

S1 BAT0 with MK:BAT (-)


S1 BAT0 with MK:BAT (+)

S30864-X211A133

1750 mm

blue
black

110/2/M
111/2/M

S1/F:AC/DC1-28b
S1/F:AC/DC1-27b

S2/1 BAT1 MK:BAT (-)


S2/1 BAT1 MK:BAT (+)

S30864-X211A134

3300 mm

blue
black

110/3/M
111/3/M

S1/F:AC/DC2-15b
S1/F:AC/DC2-14b

S2/2 BAT2 MK:BAT (-)


S2/2 BAT2 MK:BAT (+)

S30864-X211A135

4200 mm

blue
black

110/4/M
111/4/M

S1/F:AC/DC2-17b
S1/F:AC/DC2-16b

S2/3 BAT3 MK:BAT (-)


S2/3 BAT3 MK:BAT (+)

S30864-X211A136

4700 mm

blue
black

Tab. 2.55

Battery Cables for BS-240XL Service1 with BS-240XL II Service2 Racks

Cable no.

from

to

Factory no.

length

112/1

Service1, BAT 0 (+)

Service1 AC/DC 1, T 0

S30864-X211-A44

2500 mm

112/2

Service2/1, BAT 1 (+)

Service1 AC/DC 1, T 1

S30864-X211-A44

2500 mm

112/3

Service2/2, BAT 2 (+)

Service1 AC/DC 2, T 0

S30864-X211-A45

5500 mm

112/4

Service2/3, BAT 3 (+)

Service1 AC/DC 2, T 1

S30864-X211-A45

5500 mm

Tab. 2.56

Overview of the Tempresistor Cables

NOTE
The terminal clamps of MK:BATTERYV1/...V2 (with 50A breaker) have a maximum current rating of 75 Ampere.
If the 50A rating of each battery set is not sufficient for the relevant BTS configuration,
the following changes are necessary in service racks of first generation:
Replacement of each MK:BATTERYV1/...V2 (50A) by a MK:BATTERYV4 (160A).
Replacement of the old battery cabling by the standard battery cable set for the second generation.
Exception: for the connection of booth poles of each battery set of the relevant
MK:BATTERYV4, the specific cable pair (S30864-X216-A75) must be implemented.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

145

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.7.5.3

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Battery Cabling Activities


Connect the battery sets with the corresponding AC/DC frame as follows
Connect the wire 110/*/M (blue) at the -48 V terminal and the 111/*/M wire (black)
at the +0 V terminal of the MK:BATTERY.
Tighten the connection with torque wrench SW13 to 15 Nm.
Attach the cable lug of the tempresistor cable 112/* to the + pole of the battery set.
Route the wires through the rack interconnection holes the Service1 rack.
Remove the cover plate of the AC/DC frame.
Insert the wires into the matching WAGO terminals of AC/DC frame 1 or 2 in accordance with Fig. 2.146.
Plug in the tempresistor cables at the sockets T 0 and T1 (see Tab. 2.54 for BS-240
and Tab. 2.56 for BS-240XL).
precutted
in the factory

connection with F:AC/DC


Connection with MK:Battery
Fig. 2.145 Battery Cables 110*/M and 111*/M

F:AC/DC 2

F:AC/DC 1

T0

T0

T1

T1
+ - + BAT 2 BAT3

+ - + BAT 0 BAT1

Fig. 2.146 WAGO terminal for battery cabling at F:AC/DC

146

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.7.5.4

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

-48V DC Cabling BS-240 / S1 and BS-240 II / Base, Extension


An example of mixed configuration, Service1 with Base and Extension cabinets (second
generation) is shown in Fig. 2.147.

Base

Service1

Extension1

DC-Panel
0V
-48V

1)

ACTC

BR01BR02BR03 BR04BR05 BR06 BR07BR08

FAN0

FAN11

ACTC

0V
-48V
BR01BR02BR03 BR04BR05 BR06

FAN0

DC panel

FAN1

DCP:RSHS1
a
a
a a a a a a a a a a
a
a a
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1

b b

c b c c bc
c b
b b b b b b b

(to
Serv.2)

(to Ext.2)
to Ext.1
to Base

1)

first Generation

second Generation

second Generation

1) Type of cable (16 mm2): Factory No.: C39195-Z70-C105 (black)


C39195-Z70-C66 (blue)

Fig. 2.147 -48V DC connections BS-240 / S1 and BS-240II / Base and E1


The following rule must be taken into account:
The DC-breaker ratings of Service1 are limited (50A) for DC power supply the Base
and Extension racks. Therefore only CU configurations can be implemented in Base
and Extension, which DC supply currents not exceed the breaker rating of 50A.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

147

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.7.5.5

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

-48V DC Cabling BS-240 II / S1A and BS-240 / Base, Extension


The Fig. 2.148 shows an example for the -48V power supply connection of a Service1A
rack BS-240 II with Base and Extension BS-240. The Service1A rack is equipped with
the AD-panel ADPA.

NOTE
If a Service1A supplies a Base (second generation) or an Extension (second generation) the 80A DC-breakers (AD-panel: BR28, BR29 and BR30) must be replaced by a
50A type! This reduction in power for the affected rack must be considered for configuration planning! Therefore a mounting kit must be ordered with three 50A breakers (Factory no.: S30864-X215-A126).
Extension1

Base

Service1A

SIEMENS

DCP:RSHB
FAN#0

AD Panel

DCP:RSHE
ACTC

FAN#1

LE

180A

+-

ACTC
BR 33

X29
-48V
B E1 E2 B E1E2

- - -

ACTC

a a a a a

+++

LE Panel
0V -48V

a a a a

a
aa

a a a a

a
aa

c c c c c b cc c c bcc d

c c c c c b cc c c bcc d

0V

HU # 2 for LE

1413121110 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
bb c
bb b b
b b b b b

-48V

0V

-48V

462

461

to AD Panel S1A

to AD Panel S1A

HU # 3 for LE

a a a a a

1413121110 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
bb c
bb b b
b b b b b

HU # 0 for LE
HU # 1 for LE

HU # 4for LE

160A

HU # 5for LE

first Generation

first Generation

second Generation

Fig. 2.148 DC cabling BS-240 II / S1A and BS-240 / Base, E1 (S1A, ADPAV3)

Cable no.
461

462

463

Tab. 2.57

148

from

to

Color

S1A/ADPA/B/ -48V

Base/DCP inside/ 4b/-48V

blue

S1A/ADPA/B/ 0V

Base/DCP inside/ 9b/0V

black

S1A/ADPA/E1/ -48V

Extension1/DCP inside/ 4b/-48V

blue

S1A/ADPA/E1/ 0V

Extension1/DCP inside/ 9b/0V

black

S1A/ADPA/E2/ -48V

Extension2/DCP inside/ 4b/-48V

blue

S1A/ADPA/E2/ 0V

Extension2/DCP inside/ 9b/0V

black

Length

Factory No.

1.6 m

S30864-X215A127

2.2 m

S30864-X215A128

2.8 m

S30864-X215A129

Cables from Service1A to Base and Extension1/2 (S1A, ADPAV3)

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

If the Service1A is equipped with an AD-panel ADP-2V1, connect it with the Base- and
Extension racks of the BS-240 as shown in the figure below.
DCP:LEBREAK AD-Panel ADP-2V1

DCP:RSHB

DCP:RSHB

DCP:RSHE

FAN#0

FAN#1

513

ACTC

514

a a a a a

a a a a

a
aa

a a a a a

a a a a

a
aa

1413121110 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
bb c
bb b b
b b b b b

1413121110 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
bb c
bb b b
b b b b b

c c c c c b cc c c bcc d

c c c c c b cc c c bcc d

0V

-48V

0V

-48V

514

513

to AD Panel S1A

to AD Panel S1A

Base

Extension1

first Generation

first Generation

Service1A
second Generation

ACTC

515*

515-1
514-1
513-1

515-2
514-2
513-2

Batt

515* to Extension2
If the cables 513-515 1/2
should be used to connect the
Base- and Extension Racks with a Service1A
Rack, equipped with AD-panel ADPA,
cut off the connectors and remove 24 mm of
the insulation.
Fig. 2.149 DC cables from Service1A to Base and Extension1(S1A, ADP-2V1)

Cable no.
513

514

515

Tab. 2.58

from

to

Color

Length

S1A/ADP-2V1/B/-48V

Base/DCP inside/ 4b/-48V

blue

1.15 m

S1A/ADP-2V1/B/ 0V

Base/DCP inside/ 9b/0V

black

1,10 m

S1A/ADP-2V1/E1/-48V

Base/DCP inside/ 4b/-48V

blue

1.75 m

S1A/ADP-2V1/E1/ 0V

Base/DCP inside/ 9b/0V

black

1,70 m

S1A/ADP-2V1/E2/-48V

Base/DCP inside/ 4b/-48V

blue

2,35 m

S1A/ADP-2V1/E2/ 0V

Base/DCP inside/ 9b/0V

black

2,30 m

Factory No.
S30864-X215A192
S30864-X215A193
S30864-X215A194

Cables from Service1A to Base and Extension 1/2 (S1A, ADP-2V1)

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

149

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.7.5.6

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

-48V DC Cabling BS-240 / S1 and BS-240 II / S2


An example of mixed configuration, Service1 with Service2 cabinets (second generation) is shown in Fig. 2.150.

NOTE
For the combination of Service1 with Service2 racks (second generation) the implementation of the DCP:LEBREAK2V2 is mandatory.

Service2/2 Rack
SIEMENS

Service2/1 Rack
ACTC

LE Panel (S2)

33/M

FAN#1

LE Panel (S2)

FAN#0

33

FAN#1

HU # 0 for LE
HU # 1 for LE
HU # 2 for LE
HU # 3 for LE
HU # 4 for LE
HU # 5 for LE
160A

to Service2/3

a
a
a a a a a a a a a a
a
a a
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1

33

(to Ext.2)
to Ext.1
to Base

160A

160A

(to Serv.2)

second Generation

b b

c b c c bc
c b
b b b b b b b
160A

FAN#0

DCP:RSHS1

0V -48V

ACTC

33/M

Service1

SIEMENS
0V -48V

second Generation

first Generation

Cable 33: component of MK:CARSVx


Type of cable (10 mm2): Factory No.: C39195-Z70-C103 (black)
C39195-Z70-C65 (blue)
Cable 33/M: S30864-X211-A152
Type of cable (6 mm2): Factory No.: C39195-Z70-C89 (black)
C39195-Z70-C88 (blue)
(high power cable type)

Fig. 2.150 DC cabling between BS-240 / S1 and BS-240 II / S2 racks

150

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.7.5.7

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

DC Cabling BS-240 II / S1A and BS-240 / S2


An example of mixed configuration, Service1A with Service2 cabinets (first generation)
is shown in Fig. 2.151 (example with AD-panel ADPA).

NOTE
Service1A racks must not be connected to battery sets installed in Service2 racks of first
generation! Only link equipment can be installed in Service2 rack.

NOTE
The total current consumption of all link equipment of Service1A/Service2 racks must
not exceed 25A. (DC breaker rating of Breaker25 in Service1A: 25A)

Service2/2
DCP:RSHS2

Service2/1

ACTC

33/M

ACTC

33/M

to Service1A
453

33/M

a a a a

a a

FAN#0

FAN#1

453

to Service2/1
0V

Service1A

SIEMENS

DCP:RSHS2

0V

-48V

a a a a

a a

-48V

AD Panel

LE

180A

+-

ACTC
BR 33

X29
-48V
B E1 E2 B E1E2

- - -

+++

0V -48V

402
LE Panel

98 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
b
b b
b b b b

98 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
b
b b
b b b b

c c c c b c c bc

c c c c b c c bc

HU # 0 for LE
HU # 1 for LE
HU # 2 for LE
HU # 3 for LE

to Service2/3

first Generation

33/M

to Service2/2

first Generation

HU # 4for LE
HU # 5for LE
160A

33/M

second Generation

Cable 402: S30864-X215-A40; component of MK:CAR-2S1Vx (Service1A rack)


Type of cable (2,5 mm2): Factory No.: C39195-Z70-C113 (black)
C39195-Z70-C114 (blue)
Cable 453: S30864-X215-A119
Type of cable (6 mm2): Factory No.: C39195-Z70-C89 (black)
C39195-Z70-C88 (blue)
(high power cable type)
Cable 33/M: S30864-X215-A152
Type of cable (6 mm2): Factory No.: C39195-Z70-C89 (black)
C39195-Z70-C88 (blue)
(high power cable type)

Fig. 2.151

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

DC cables between BS-240II/ S1A and BS-240/S2 (S1A, ADPAV3)

151

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

DCP:RSHS2

DCP:RSHS2
ACTC

33/M

ACTC

503

33/M

a a a a

a a

FAN#1

to Service1A

to Service2/1
0V

FAN#0

503

33/M

0V

-48V

a a a a

a a

-48V

98 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
b
b b
b b b b

98 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
b
b b
b b b b

c c c c b c c bc

c c c c b c c bc

33/M

to Service2/3
first Generation

33/M

to Service2/2
first Generation

Service1A
second Generation

Cable No. 503: S30864-X215-A164, length 1.30 m


Cable No. 33/M: S30864-X215-A152, length 0.90 m

Fig. 2.152 DC cables between BS-240UII/S1A and BS-240/S2 (S1A, ADP-2V1)

152

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.7.5.8

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

DC Cabling BS-240XL / S1 and BS-240XL II / Base, Extension


An example of mixed configuration, Service1 with Base and Extension cabinets (second
generation) is shown in Fig. 2.153.

Base

Service1

Extension1

DC-Panel
0V
-48V

1)

ACTC

BR01BR02BR03 BR04BR05 BR06 BR07BR08

DCP:R12S1

FAN0

FAN11

ACTC

0V
-48V
BR01BR02BR03 BR04BR05 BR06

FAN0

DC panel

FAN1

a a a a
a

a a

a
b

a a
b b

a
b

13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
b
c
c
c c
b b
b
b

b b b b

(to
Serv.2)

35

34

to Ext.1
to Base

1)

first Generation

second Generation

second Generation

1) Type of cable (25 mm2): Factory No.: C39195-Z70-C134 (black)


C39195-Z70-C135 (blue)
(Component of MK:CARSV1 / S30864-X215-A28)

Fig. 2.153 DC connections between BS-240XL / S1 and BS-240XLII / Base, E1

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

153

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.7.5.9

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

DC Cabling BS-240XL II / S1A and BS-240XL / Base, Extension


The Fig. 2.154 shows an example of the -48V power supply connections between a
Service1A rack and Base / Extension rack (first generation).

Extension1

Base

Service1A

SIEMENS

DC-Panel
FAN#0

DC-Panel
ACTC

FAN#1

ACTC

DCP:R12B
AD Panel

LE

180A

+X29
-48V
B E1 E2 B E1E2

- - -

+++

LE Panel
0V -48V

HU # 0 for LE

a
a
a a a a
a a a
a aa a
1514131211 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1

bb bb

bb b

bb bb

bb b b

b b

c c c b

c c c c

c c c c b

c c b

HU # 1 for LE

-48V

413

c c c

0V

-48V

414

to AD Panel S1A

160A

to AD Panel S1A

b bb

0V

HU # 2 for LE

160A

a
a
a aa a
a a a
a a
13121110 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1

c c c c b

HU # 3 for LE

ACTC
BR 33

DCP:R12E

second Generation

first Generation

first Generation

1) Type of cable (25 mm2): Factory No.: C39195-Z70-C134 (black)


C39195-Z70-C135 (blue)

Fig. 2.154 DC connections between BS-240XLII / S1A and BS-240XL / Base, E1

154

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.7.5.10

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

DC Cabling BS-240XL / S1 and BS-240XL II / S2


An example of mixed configuration, Service1 with Service2 cabinets (second generation) is displayed in Fig. 2.155.

NOTE
For the combination of Service1 with Service2 racks (second generation) the implementation of the DCP:LEBREAK2V2 is mandatory!

Service2/2 Rack
SIEMENS

Service2/1 Rack
ACTC

LE Panel (S2)

FAN#0

DCP:RSHS1

0V -48V

ACTC

33/M

Service1

SIEMENS
0V -48V

33/M

FAN#1

LE Panel (S2)

FAN#0

33

FAN#1

HU # 0 for LE
HU # 1 for LE
HU # 2 for LE
HU # 3 for LE
HU # 4 for LE
HU # 5 for LE

to Service2/3

FAN#0

a
a
a a a a a a a a a a a a a

15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8

b b

FAN#1

33

to Ext.1
to Base

160A

(to
Serv.2)

160A

160A
160A

6 5 4 3 2 1

c b c c bc
c b
b b b b b b b

HU # 0 for LE
HU # 1 for LE
HU # 2 for LE
HU # 3 for LE
HU # 4 for LE
HU # 5 for LE

second Generation

second Generation

first Generation

Cable 33: component of MK:CARSVx


Type of cable (10 mm2): Factory No.: C39195-Z70-C103 (black)
C39195-Z70-C65 (blue)
Cable 33/M: S30864-X211-A152
Type of cable (6 mm2): Factory No.: C39195-Z70-C89 (black)
C39195-Z70-C88 (blue)
(high power cable type)

Fig. 2.155 DC connections between BS-240XL / S1 and BS-240XL II / S2

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

155

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.7.5.11

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

DC Cabling BS-240XL II / S1A and BS-240XL / S2


An example of mixed configuration, Service1A with Service2 cabinets (first generation)
is shown in Fig. 2.156.

NOTE
Service1A racks must not be connected to battery sets installed in Service2 racks of first
generation! Only link equipment can be installed in Service2 rack.

NOTE
The total current consumption of all link equipment of Service1A/Service2 racks must
not exceed 25A. (DC breaker rating of Breaker25 in Service1A: 25A)

Service2/2
DCP:RSHS2

Service2/1

ACTC

33/M

ACTC

33/M

to Service1A
453

33/M

a a a a

a a

FAN#0

FAN#1

453

to Service2/1
0V

Service1A

SIEMENS

DCP:RSHS2

0V

-48V

a a a a

a a

-48V

AD Panel

LE

180A

+-

ACTC
BR 33

X29
-48V
B E1 E2 B E1E2

- - -

+++

0V -48V

402
LE Panel

98 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
b
b b
b b b b

98 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
b
b b
b b b b

c c c c b c c bc

c c c c b c c bc

HU # 3 for LE

to Service2/2

160A

to Service2/3

33/M

HU # 1 for LE
HU # 2 for LE

160A

33/M

HU # 0 for LE

first Generation

first Generation

second Generation

Cable 402: S30864-X215-A40; component of MK:CAR-2S1Vx (Service1A rack)


Type of cable (2,5 mm2): Factory No.: C39195-Z70-C113 (black)
C39195-Z70-C114 (blue)
Cable 453: S30864-X215-A119
Type of cable (6 mm2): Factory No.: C39195-Z70-C89 (black)
C39195-Z70-C88 (blue)
(high power cable type)
Cable 33/M: S30864-X215-A152
Type of cable (6 mm2): Factory No.: C39195-Z70-C89 (black)
C39195-Z70-C88 (blue)
(high power cable type)

Fig. 2.156 DC connections between BS-240XL II/ S1A and BS-240XL / S2

156

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.7.5.12

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

SELIC-Cabling between the Racks (mixed Configuration)


In case of extension of an existing Base Station system with additional Extension racks
the following combinations are possible:
BS-240 Base -> BS-240 II Extension
BS-240 Base -> BS-240XL / 240XL II Extension
BS-240 II Base -> BS-240 Extension
BS-240 II Base -> BS-240XL / 240XL II Extension
BS-240XL / 240XL II Base -> BS-240 Extension
BS-240XL / 240XL II Base -> BS-240 II Extension
The necessary cables for extension combinations have to be ordered additionally (see
Tab. 2.59 and Tab. 2.60). For mixed configuration with distance between the racks
(Tab. 2.60) the cable sets include an appropriate CAN-Bus cable.
Rack type

Selic cable lengths with Factory No.: S30864-*


BS-240 Ext.

BS-240 Base

BS-240 II Base

Tab. 2.59

1920 mm

1460 mm

X210-A68

X210-A27

cable length 1920 mm

see standard
configuration

1460 mm

cable length 1460 mm

1460 mm

S30864-*

X210-A75

see standard
configuration

X210-A68

X210-A74

Selic cable lengths with Factory No.: S30864-*


BS-240 Ext.

BS-240 Base

BS-240 II Base

BS-240XL /
240XL II Base

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

X210-A69

SELIC-cabling (mixed configuration without distance between cabinets)

Rack type

Tab. 2.60

BS-240XL /
240XL II Ext.

cable length see standard


configuration
S30864-*

S30864-*
BS-240XL /
240XL II Base

BS-240 II Ext.

BS-240 II Ext.

BS-240XL /
240XL II Ext.

cable length

4120 mm or
6970 mm

4070 mm or
6920 mm

3612 mm or
6462 mm

S30864-*

X211-A123 or
A118

X211-A132 or
A133

X211-A125 or
A120

cable length

4070 mm or
6920 mm

4070 mm or
6920 mm

3612 mm or
6462 mm

S30864-*

X211-A132 or
A133

X211-A126 or
A121

X211-A134 or
A135

cable length

3612 mm or
6462 mm

3612 mm or
6462 mm

3114 mm or
5960 mm

S30864-*

X211-A136 or
A137

X211-A138 or
A139

X211-A122 or
A116

SELIC-cabling (mixed configuration with distance between cabinets)

157

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.7.6
2.7.6.1

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Combination of Racks with different Heights


BS-240 II / S1A with BS-240XL II / Extension
A BS-240XL II Extension rack can be added to an existing BS-240 II Base rack to increase BTS capacity.
screening measure
see view B
cable duct

Extension1

414

screening measure
see view A

ACTC

0V
-48V

cable ties

BR01BR02BR03 BR04BR05 BR06

FAN0
Service1A

Base

FAN#0

MSU:DC

DC panel

FAN1

413
ACTC

0V
-48V

FAN#1
BR01BR02BR03 BR04BR05 BR06 BR07BR08

FAN0

AD Panel

LE

180A

+-

ACTC
BR 33

X29
-48V
B E1 E2 B E1E2

- - -

FAN1

+++

LE Panel
0V -48V

HU # 0 for LE
HU # 1 for LE
HU # 2 for LE
HU # 3 for LE
HU # 4for LE

160A

HU # 5for LE

BS-240 II

BS-240 II

BS-240XL II

Fig. 2.157 DC connection (BS-240 / S1A with BS-240XL II / Extension)


Use the following pre-fabricated cables for connection of the racks:
Cable 414: DC cable pair (25 mm2) with braided shield, copper wires 0.15 mm,
tinned, C39195-Z70-C158 (BK Type S07V-C4V5-K)
Cable 446: Grounding cable (16 mm2), C39195-Z70-C105 (BK Type S07V-K)
The outer insulation of both DC-cables that to be routed through the cable feeding module of the Service1A rack has to be removed at the EMC-gasket (see Fig. 2.158). This
measure guarantees a proper contact between the cable screen and the mesh screened
rubber profiles.

158

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

-48V

+0V

414

15 mm

EMC - bar

stress - relieving

cable ties

Fig. 2.158 (View A) Preparation of the DC cables at the cable feeding module
Route the DC-cables to the rear side of the Extension rack in a suitable cable duct. Remove the insolation of the cables approximately 15 mm for contact of the screen to the
stress relieving clamp at the right edge of rack (Fig. 2.159). Connect the cables 414-1
and 414-2 to the terminal block of the MSU:DC.
DC -cables from Service1A rack
common ground cable
from Service1A rack

446

rear side of rack

grounding bolts

screen connection
414-2

+0V

414-1

-48V

to MSU:DC

Fig. 2.159 (View B) Cable connections to Ground and MSU:DC of Extension


The connection between the racks will be completed by the routing of the common
ground cable no. 446. The cable is equipped with cable lugs at both ends and will be
attached to the M8 ground bolts at the rear side of the EMI panel.
For SELIC cabling refer to the chapter 2.7.5.12.
For CAN-Bus cabling refer to the chapter 2.7.4.10.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

159

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.7.7

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Installation of Link Equipment


The link equipment acts as a front end, to provide the Abis interface. Different equipment
can be used for wire or radio transmission. Which equipment will be used depends on
customer requirements.
The number of link equipment, that can be installed depends on the height of the units.

NOTE
For connections between Abis interface in the Base rack and link equipment in the Service rack, pay attention to the recommendation CCITT G.703.
The receive level compared with the transmit level should not be lower than 6 dB.
For the installation of link equipment, the mounting kit MK:LE is needed always and designed for 19 units. The MK:LE will fixed at the mounting bars on the right and left side
of the rack. 4 screws Torx T30 are needed for fixing.
The MK:LE holds the customer-dependent frames for microwave equipment or the
frame for 2 NTPM, F:NT (german market only).
The installation of link equipment in the mounting kit has always to start at the top of the
mounting kit below the DC-panel without a gap, so that the airflow inside the rack will
not be affected.

MK:LE

Fig. 2.160 Mounting Kit for Link Equipment MK:LE

160

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.7.7.1

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation of Microwave Equipment


In case of microwave transmission, the indoor units inside the Service rack have to be
connected via the microwave antenna cables with the tower mounted outdoor units.

NOTE
The outer insulation of the microwave antenna cables has to be removed in the area of
the cable feeding module for proper ground contact to the metal lids.
Connect the microwave antenna cables at the indoor units as follows:
1. Remove the front part of cable feeding module.
2. Feed the microwave cables through the cable feeding module forward to the front
connectors of microwave indoor units.
3. Fix the microwave cables at the front connectors of the indoor units. The connector
type and fixing torque depends on the equipment, provided by the customer.
4. Bend the microwave cables into the a position that it is able to close the cable feeding module without any pressure and tension.
5. Fix removable part in its original position.
6. Fix each cable at the strain reliefs of the feeding module with cable ties.
The next step is the connection of the microwave indoor units with the -48 VDC circuit of
the Service rack and the alarm lines at the spring terminals of the ACTC. Because construction differences between the BS-240 and the BS-240 II rack, proceed in different
ways. In case of BS-240 Service racks perform the following steps:
1. Connect the microwave power supply / alarm cables (S30864-X211-A57) at the front
connectors of ACTC (see the following figure).
2. Route the cables down to the microwave units and fix them at the right subrack
mounting bar with cable ties.
3. Attach equipment-specific connectors at the cable ends that should be connected to
the microwave units.

Service rack
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9
microwave connectors
(ACTC)
up to 9 cables
S30864-K2045-X-*-7483
frame for
link equipment

AL15_P Wave (white)


AL15_P AL_GND (black)

DC_Wave... PUE +0 V (red)


DC_Wave... MUE -48 V (blue)
Fig. 2.161 Cabling for link equipment (BS-240 / 240XL)

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

161

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Install the DC-supply wires in case of the BS-240 II Service1A rack as follows:
1. Remove the cover plate of the DC-distribution block at the DC-panel.
2. Fit the breakers for link equipment (can be 4A breaker, V39118-Z4005-A91 or 10A,
V39118-Z4005-A91). The number of breakers depends on the volume of microwave
units, that should be installed.
3. Connect the blue/black twisted wire pairs (cable no. 401, S30864-X215-A39) at the
2-pole connectors X25F (R)- X32F (R) of the DC-distribution block.
4. Route the cables down to the microwave units and fix them at the left subrack mounting bar with cable ties.
5. Attach the equipment-specific connector at the cable ends, that should be connected at the DC-input of the microwave units.
remove the cover plate

Fig. 2.162 Connection of the DC supply cables (cable no. 401)


Install the alarm line connection between the microwave units and the ACTC:
1. Measure the distance between the alarm output of the microwave units and the terminal block of the ACTC module in the F:ACTC-2V1.
2. Cut stranded wires with a cross section in the range of 0,08 mm2 - 0,5 mm2 (e.g.
LI7Y 2x0,34/1,3 blue/black) to the required length.
3. Remove 10 mm of the insulation and attach the wires to the matching spring terminals of the ACTC.
4. Route the wires down to the microwave units and fix the bundle at the right subrack
mounting bar with cable ties.
5. If necessary, equip the stranded wires with a connector. The type depends on the
alarm interface of the microwave units.
The installation steps of the DC-supply and alarm cables for the microwave units in the
BS-240 II Service2 racks are equal to the Service 1A rack. In this case, the ACTC module is part of the DC-panel and located on the right of the link equipment breakers.
In the DC-panels of the Service2 rack, the link equipment breakers BR01- BR06 (connectors X25F (R) - X30F (R) can be used for the protection of the microwave units.
The following graphics should illustrate the DC cabling in both rack types.

162

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

+0 V

4A or
10A

4A or
10A

4A or
10A

4A or
10A

X32F

X31F

mWave 7

mWave 6

mWave 4

mWave 5

X28F
mWave 3

mWave 11

mWave 2

mWave 10

mWave 1

mWave 9

X32R

4A or
10A

X31R

4A or
10A

X30F

4A or
10A

X30R

4A or
10A

X29F

BR08

X29R

BR07

X28R

BR06

X27F

BR05

X27R

BR04

X26F

BR03

X26R

BR02

X25F

BR01

mWave 0

mWave 8

X25R

-48 V

cables no. 401

cables no. 401


example for 2 microwave units per breaker

example for 1 microwave unit per breaker

Fig. 2.163 DC distribution block with microwave units in Service1A (BS-240 II)

+0 V

4A or
10A

ACTC, FAN

mWave 5

mWave 11

mWave 4

mWave 10

mWave 3

mWave 9

mWave 2

mWave 8

mWave 1

mWave 7

cables no. 401

cable no. 408

ACTC, DC IN X32F

4A or
10A

X32R

4A or
10A

X31F

4A or
10A

X31R

4A or
10A

X30F

4A or
10A

X30R

4A or
10A

X29F

4A or
10A

X29R

BR08

X28F

BR07

X28R

BR06

X27F

BR05

X27R

BR04

X26F

BR03

X26R

BR02

X25F

BR01

mWave 0

mWave 6

X25R

-48 V

407

Fig. 2.164 DC distribution block with microwave units in Service2 (BS-240 II)
The next step is the routing of the PCM-lines between the OVPT / ABISCON in the Base
rack and the PCM interfaces of the microwave indoor units. Therefore the pre-fabricated
cable S30864-X207-A8-*-7402 should be used. The cable is used as a splitter.
It consists of four single cables with Sub D-9 female connectors for the connection of a
microwave unit at each connector. The cables are attached to a common Sub D-25 female connector. The cable will be expanded with cable S30864-X211-A112 for the connection with the OVPT / ABISCON.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

163

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Signal Name

Plug Sub D9 f
Pin No.

Plug Sub D25


Pin No.

OVPT Terminal
Pin No.

cable no. S30864-X207-A8-*-7402


cable no. S30864-X211-A112
PCM 1 - ULA

22

PCM 1 - ULB

14

20

GND/G

18

PCM 1 - DLA

21

PCM 1 - DLB

15

19

GND/G

---

---

23

PCM 2 - ULA

16

PCM 2 - ULB

16

14

GND/G

18

18

PCM 2 - DLA

15

PCM 2 - DLB

17

13

GND/G

---

---

17

PCM 3 - ULA

10

PCM 3 - ULB

19

GND/G

12

PCM 3 - DLA

PCM 3 - DLB

20

GND/G

---

---

11

PCM 4 - ULA

PCM 4 - ULB

21

GND/G

23

PCM 4 - DLA

10

PCM 4 - DLB

22

GND/G

---

---

GND/G

---

---

28

Tab. 2.61

Pre-fabricated cables between OVPT/ABISCON and the microwave units

An overview about the complete microwave cabling of both rack designs is given in the
following figure.

164

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

to ODU
Service Rack

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

to ODU

BS-240 II / 240XL II

BS-240 / 240XL
Service Rack

Base Rack

Base Rack
top view

top view

OVPT

OVPT
7)

7)

EMI panel

EMI panel
ACTC

DC panel

rack front

ACTC

rack front

1)

breaker panel

1)
alarm lines

-48Vdc 5)
supply lines

m
Sub D 25
f 4)

Sub D 9
m
Sub D 25

3) twisted pair

Sub D 9

Sub D 25

PCM1
PCM0

4)

SubD 9

Sub D 25

F:CORE

m
f 4)

-48 Vdc supply and


alarm lines 6)

f
m

m
f 4)

PCM1
PCM0

f
m

SubD 9

F:CORE
2)

2)

LE1-4

LE1-4

LE5-8

LE5-8

1) integral part of cabinet cabling


2) has to be prepared on site
3) pair of stranded wires, e.g. C39195-Z75-C510 (Type: LI7Y 2x0,34/1,3 BL/SW VS)
4) can be ordered as prepared cable (Octopus cable), order-no.: S30864-X207-A8-*-7402
5) can be ordered as prepared cable, order-no.: S30864-X215-A39, (twisted pair, blue: -48 Vdc, black: 0 Vdc)
6) can be ordered as prepared cable, order-no.: S30861-K2045-X-*-7483, (power cable for microwave module)
7) can be ordered as prepared cable, order-no.: S30864-X211-A112

Fig. 2.165 Overview of microwave cabling

2.7.7.2

Installation of NTPM
In case of transmission via terrestrial lines, the NTPMs are placed inside the Service
rack, that is equipped with a mounting kit for NTPM, called frame F:NT.

NOTE
It is necessary, to install a mounting kit MK:LE before mounting of the F:NT.
Each frame F:NT provides the equivalent space of 3 HU, allowing the installation of up
to 2 NTPM side by side.
The frame F:NT provides 3 interfaces:
SubD 9, male with M3 fixings for -48 V output
SubD 25, female with M3 fixings for PCM input
SubD 25, male with M3 fixings for PCM output
In case of the BS-240, the power supply cable from the frame F:NT to the ACTC is part
of the F:NT. For the BS-240 II Service1A / Service2 racks use the DC power cable

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

165

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

S30864-X216-A109 for the connections between the link equipment breakers (4A) and
the -48VDC input of the F:NT.
For the PCM connection between the OVPT/ABISCON and the F:NT the pre-fabricated
cable S30864-X211-A59 should be used. An overview of the cabling if the F:NT is installed inside the racks is given in the following figure.

BS-240 II / 240XL II

PCM lines

Base Rack

Service Rack

OVPT OVPT
PCM0 PCM1

BS-240 / 240XL

PCM lines

Base Rack

Service Rack

OVPT OVPT
PCM0 PCM1

6)

4)

4)

2)

2)
EMI panel

DC panel

ACTC

EMI panel
ACTC

rack front

rack front

-48 V
2)

-48Vdc

3) supply lines

1)

1)

F:CORE

PCM1
PCM0

F:CORE

PCM1
PCM0

F:NT1

F:NT1
7)

6)

5)

F:NT2

1) Integral part of cabinet cabling


2) has to be prepared on site
3) power supply cable: S30864-X216-A109
4) cable S30864-X211-A59

7)

5)

F:NT2

5) see Figure: Interface on frame F:NT


6) maximum of four PCM links per OVPT
7) 2 PCM links per F:NT if fully equipped with 2 modules

Fig. 2.166 Overview of NTPM cabling variants

166

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

- 48 VDC
to OVPT / ABISCON
external PCM lines

Fig. 2.167 Interfaces on frame F:NT

Name

F:NT -48 V, subD 9 female pin

0V

1,2,6

-48 V

4,5,9

Tab. 2.62

Pin Assignments of -48 V interface of frame F:NT

Signal name

F:NT PCM-INPUT subD 25


female pin

F:NT PCM-OUTPUT subD 25


male pin

PCM 1 - ULA

PCM 1 - ULB

14

14

GND/G

PCM 1 - DLA

PCM 1 - DLB

15

15

GND/G

16

16

PCM 2 - ULA

PCM 2 - ULB

17

17

GND/G

PCM 2 - DLA

PCM 2 - DLB

18

18

GND/G

19

19

Tab. 2.63

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Pin Assignments of PCM-Input and -Output connector of frame F:NT

167

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.8

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Installation of the Modules


For later extension or maintenance it is useful to have a basic knowledge about the correct removal and replacement of the Core- and RF modules. Two variants for the fixing
of the modules in the subracks does exist. A lever mechanism will be used for fixing of
the Core modules COBA and COSA. Fixing screws at the upper and lower edge are
used for securing of the RF modules.The handling is shown in the figure below.

fixing screw

lever mechanism
Fig. 2.168 Fixing variants of the modules

push together

lever mechanism in open position


Fig. 2.169 Handling of the lever mechanism
To prevent the installation of the plug-in modules at incorrect mounting positions, each
relevant modules provide code keys.
Module
DUAMCO

FICOM

DIAMCO

CU

COBA

COSA

Tab. 2.64

168

Code Key

Module HW Code Key

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

code key no.

Fig. 2.170 Location of the code key no.


Pay attention to the following hints:
After removal of a module check the proper condition of the code key plugs on the
backplane.
Before a module will be plugged-in check the correct setting of the code key number,
this is to prevent damages at the backplane connectors (see table below).
Insert the modules without pressure.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

169

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.9

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Nonstandard Installation Works


If an already installed BS-240 should be extended with Service2 racks to provide a longer battery backup time, the installation of a second AC/DC frame inside the Service1
rack can be necessary.

2.9.1

Installation of the AC/DC Frame


The AC/DC frame consist of the parts as shown in the figure below.
Complete the air duct first, but do not mount the duct before insert the fan unit connectors into the fitting holes at the rear of the AC/DC frame.

AC/DC frame

air duct
air flaps

front cover

Fig. 2.171 Components of the AC/DC frame


Complete the air duct as displayed in Fig. 2.172 and Fig. 2.173 in steps as follows:
Insert both air flaps into the air duct frame, so that the flaps will be opened by the
air outlet stream.
Cover the air duct edges with the 4 rubber sealings.

Fig. 2.172 Fitting of the air flaps

170

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

rubber sealing

Fig. 2.173 Setup of the rubber sealing


Mount the AC/DC frame inside the Service1 rack as follows:
Setup the AC/DC frame in the position as shown in the figure below onto the battery
tray.
Open the cable ring in the upper rear of the rack and select the fan cables no. 51 and
no. 52.
Insert the cable connectors into the fitting holes, so that the connectors can be easy
moved inside the hole.
Pay attention to the correct cable no. because the connectors can not pulled out
without any damages.

51

52

Fig. 2.174 Plug-in of the fan cables


Install the connections between AC/DC frame 1 and 2:
Mount the prepared air duct at the rear of the AC/DC frame with both screws provided with the air duct parts (see Fig. 2.175).
Disconnect cable 91 from the CAN-OUT connector at the backplane of the AC/DC
frame 1 (see Fig. 2.175) and pull down the cable to AC/DC frame 2.
Plug-in cable no. 89 at the CAN-OUT connector of AC/DC frame 1. The cable is provided with AC/DC frame 2.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

171

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

disconnect cable no. 91

screw

AC/DC frame 1
Fig. 2.175 Air duct mounting, disconnection CAN-BUS cable no. 91

89
114
114

AC/DC frame 1

AC/DC frame 2

Fig. 2.176 Connection CAN-BUS and Interconnection Cable

Plug-in the interconnection cable no. 114 at the connector position as displayed in
Fig. 2.176.
Plug-in the CAN-BUS cable no. 89 at connector CAN-OUT of the AC/DC frame 1.
Plug-in the interconnection cable no. 114 at the connector position as displayed in
Fig. 2.176 at AC/DC frame 2.
Connect the cables no. 91 and 114 as shown in Fig. 2.177.
89

91

114
AC/DC frame 2

AC/DC frame 2

Fig. 2.177 Cable Connections at AC/DC frame 2

172

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Connect the CAN-BUS cable no. 89 at the CAN-IN connector of the AC/DC frame 2.
Lift up the AC/DC frame to its mounting position (without gap below AC/DC frame 1).
Fix the frame with 4 screws Torx T30.

Install the -48 V DC-connections to the DC-Panel of the Service1 rack and connect battery systems BAT2 and BAT3.
Connect the cables no. 107 and 108 at the DC clamping block of the AC/DC frame 2.
Connect the cables no. 110/3 and 111/3 (BAT2), 110/4 and 111/4 (BAT3) at the DC
clamping block of the AC/DC frame 2 if BS-240 Service2 are used.
In case of BS-240 II Service2 racks the cables no. 110/3M and 111/3M (BAT2),
110/4M and 111/4M (BAT3) have to be connect (see figure below).

107/A

107/B
108/A

108/B 107/A
107/B

108/B
111/4M

108/A
111/3M
110/3M

110/4M

AC/DC frame 1

AC/DC frame 2
Fig. 2.178 Connection of DC and Battery Cables

Route the cable no. 229 (twisted pair wires, black / blue) from the AC/DC frame 2 to
to the ACTC of the Service1 rack.
Remove the jumper at the BB1connector of the ACTC and insert the plug of the
cable no. 229.

229

remove jumper

229
Fig. 2.179 Routing of the Battery Breaker Cable
Complete the installation of the AC/DC frame 2:
Plug in both fan units. Push down the lids (see Fig. 2.180) during the fitting.
Fix the cover plates of the AC/DC frames 1 and 2.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

173

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

press

Fig. 2.180 Fitting of the fans, closing the AC/DC frame

2.10

Setup of System Cabling


The system cabling consists of connections are installed on the front of the rack. Cabling
configurations depend on the different equipping variants (e.g., type of combining, capacity stage) and the cell configuration of the site.
The system cabling is already installed in the factory. This section provides information
for setup additional system cables for extension of RF modules or the cell configuration
must be changed.
System cables will be shipped in a box to avoid twisting and damage. Before starting the
connection procedure, refer to the site documentation and determine the types and
number of cables.
The list of variant numbers (content of the site specific documentation) is needed for the
correct setup of the cabling between the modules.

174

NOTE
For further informations refer to Configuration Rules for System Cabling.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.10.1

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

System Cabling with semi-rigid Cables


NOTE
A minimum bending radius of 10 mm (semi-rigid.141 AI) and 3,5 mm (semi-rigid .86 AI)
must be ensured.
Fix the system cables at SMA connectors with a torque wrench set to 1,00 Nm and at
SMC connectors with a torque wrench set to 0,35 Nm.
Terminate all unused connectors of the antenna combiners with 50 Ohm load resistors!

Fig. 2.181 Example of system cabling with semi-rigid cable


The following table provides an overview of the types and functionality of the prefabricated cables.
connection

code number

length Path

connector

cable type

DUAMCO 0/3CU 0/1,4/5

C39195-Z80C113

1600
mm

RX

SMC,90,male/
SMC,90,male

semi-rigid
.086 Al

DUAMCO 1/2CU 2/3,6/7

C39195-Z80C118

1250
mm

RX

SMC,90,male/
SMC,90,male

semi-rigid
.086 Al

DUAMCO 0/3CU 0/1,4/5

C39195-Z80C160

1250
mm

TX

SMA,90,male/
SMA,90,male

semi-rigid
.141 Al

DUAMCO 1/2CU 2/3,6/7

C39195-Z80C114

1050
mm

TX

SMA,90,male/
SMA,90,male

semi-rigid
.141 Al

FICOM-0/3
CU 0/1,4/5

C39195-Z80C160

1250
mm

TX

SMA,90,male/
SMA,90,male

semi-rigid
.141 Al

FICOM-1/2
CU 2/3,6/7

C39195-Z80C114

1050
mm

TX

SMA,90,male/
SMA,90,male

semi-rigid
.141 Al

DIAMCO-0
CU 1,2/3,4/6,7

C39195-Z80C116

600
mm

RX

SMC,90,male/
SMC,90,male

semi-rigid
.086 Al

Tab. 2.65

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Functionality of system cables BS-240 / 240 II

175

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

connection

connector

cable type

C39195-Z80C117

750
mm

RX

SMC,90,male/
SMC,90,male

semi-rigid
.086 Al

DIAMCO-1
CU 2/3,4,6/7

C39195-Z80C116

600
mm

RX

SMC,90,male/
SMC,90,male

semi-rigid
.086 Al

HPDU (Rack)DIAMCO

C39195-Z80C174

1250
mm

RX

SMA,90,male/ semi-rigid
N-Con,90,male .141 Al

HPDUFICOM (Rack)

C39195-Z80C173

400
mm

TX

7/16,90,male/
7/16,90,male

DIAMCO (Rack
0) DIAMCO (Rack
1)

C39195-Z80C176

2700
mm

Cas- SMA,90,male/ Coax flexible


cad N-Con,90,male

BIAS-T - DIAMCO

C39195-Z80C181

1450
mm

RX

SMA,90,male/ semi-rigid
N-Con,90,male .141 Al

BIAS-T - HPDU

C39195-Z80C180

410
mm

RX

SMA,90,male/
SMA,90,male

1/2 jum-per
cable

semi-rigid
.141 Al

Functionality of system cables BS-240 / 240 II

connection

code number length

Path

connector

cable type

DUAMCO 0/3- CU C39195-Z800/1/6/7


C206

1800
mm

RX

SMC,90,male/ semi-rigid
SMC,90,male .086 Al

DUAMCO 0/1/2/3
CU 2/3/8/9

C39195-Z80C113

1600
mm

RX

SMC,90,male/ semi-rigid
SMC,90,male .086 Al

DUAMCO 0/1/2/3- C39195-Z80CU 4/5/10/11


C118

1350
mm

RX

SMC,90,male/ semi-rigid
SMC,90,male .086 Al

DUAMCO 0/3- CU C39195-Z800/1/6/7


C204

1650
mm

TX

SMA,90,male/ semi-rigid
SMA,90,male .141 Al

DUAMCO 0/1/2/3- C39195-Z80CU 2/3/8/9


C160

1250
mm

TX

SMA,90,male/ semi-rigid
SMA,90,male .141 Al

DUAMCO 0/1/2/3- C39195-Z80CU 4/5/10/11


C114

1050
mm

TX

SMA,90,male/ semi-rigid
SMA,90,male .141 Al

Tab. 2.66

176

length Path

DIAMCO-0/1
CU 0/5

Tab. 2.65

code number

Functionality of system cables BS-240XL / XL II

NOTE
In case of expansion of a FICOM base module with FICOM expansion modules, a short
semi-flex cable (C39195-Z80-C137) will be connected between the RF/EXP connectors
(N-type, female) of the modules. Fix the cable at the N-type connectors and screw the
connection to a fingertight torque (approx. 1,00 Nm). Avoid the twisting of the cable
connectors during the connection.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.10.2

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

System Cabling with Flexi-Cables


NOTE
Fix the system cables at SMA connectors with a torque wrench set to 1,00 Nm and at
SMC connectors with a torque wrench set to 0,35 Nm. Terminate all unused connectors
of the antenna combiners with 50 Ohm load resistors!
The cables have to be routed in such a way that allows the ease exchange of modules
(CUs, Combiners and FANs). For this reason BTS Base-/Extension cabinets which have
been equipped with flexible HF cabling in the factory always, come with a pair of cableretainers fitted left-and right hand side at the bottom of each sub-rack (exception: lowest
subrack of a cabinet).
Route the cables, so that the LED-indications of the modules are visible and the test
adapter connectors are accessible.
The task of these cable retainers - which are bended sheet metal parts - is to keep those
flexible HF-cables in a neat position which inter-connect subracks.
If a customer decides to retrofit an 1th generation base station - which has not been
equipped with cable-retainers -with flexible HF cables, these cables must be loosely fitted with cable-ties.

NOTE
Attention: Fitting of HF cables with cable-ties is not allowed for base stations equipped
with these cable retainers.

Fig. 2.182 Example of system cabling with flexible cables

NOTE
The minimum single bending radius of the flexible cables is 20 mm. The minimum repeated bending radius is 40 mm. The exceptional length of the cables have to be stored
inside the vertical space between the subracks and the rack. The horizontal space below each subrack have not to be used to store the extra length of the system cables or
anything else. This space is used as an air inlet for cooling.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

177

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

connection

178

length

Path

connector

ACOM - FlexCU

S30864-X217-A14 1800 mm RX

SMC,90,female/
SMC,90,female

ACOM - FlexCU

S30864-X217-A13 1600 mm RX

SMC,90,female/
SMC,90,female

ACOM - FlexCU

S30864-X217-A15 1400 mm RX

SMC,90,female/
SMC,90,female

ACOM - FlexCU

S30864-X217-A26 600 mm

RX

SMC,90,male/
SMC,90,male

ACOM - FlexCU

S30864-X217-A27 750 mm

RX

SMC,90,male/
SMC,90,male

ACOM - FlexCU

S30864-X217-A48 400 mm

RX

SMC,90,male/
SMC,90,male

ACOM - FlexCU

S30864-X217-A50 1000 mm RX

SMC,90,male/
SMC,90,male

ACOM - FlexCU

S30864-X217-A51 1200 mm RX

SMC,90,male/
SMC,90,male

ACOM - FlexCU

S30864-X217-A39 390 mm

TX

SMA,90,male/
SMA,90,male

ACOM - FlexCU

S30864-X217-A49 600 mm

TX

SMA,90,male/
SMA,90,male

ACOM - FlexCU

S30864-X217-A54 800 mm

TX

SMA,90,male/
SMA,90,male

ACOM - FlexCU

S30864-X217-A25 1050 mm TX

SMA,90,male/
SMA,90,male

ACOM - FlexCU

S30864-X217-A24 1250 mm TX

SMA,90,male/
SMA,90,male

ACOM - FlexCU

S30864-X217-A52 1400 mm TX

SMA,90,male/
SMA,90,male

ACOM - FlexCU

S30864-X217-A23 1600 mm TX

SMA,90,male/
SMA,90,male

ACOM - FlexCU

S30864-X217-A53 1800 mm TX

SMA,90,male/
SMA,90,male

Tab. 2.67

code number

BS-240 II / 240 XL II, flexible system cable types

NOTE
In case of expansion of a FICOM base module with FICOM expansion modules, a short
semi-flex cable (C39195-Z80-C137) will be connected between the RF/EXP connectors
(N-type, female) of the modules. N-type connectors should work when 'finger tight".
There doesn't appear to be a consensus on how much torque this is in detail. Connector
suppliers recommends a torque of approx. 1,00 Nm. Avoid the twisting of the cable connectors during the connection.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

2.10.3

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Terminators
It is necessary to terminate all unused RF-connectors of the RF-modules with 50 Ohm
load resistors.The following resistors are used:
C39195-Z80-C30 for SMA connectors
C39195-Z80-C31 for SMC connectors
Fix the terminators at SMA connectors with a torque wrench set 1.00 Nm and at SMC
connectors with a torque wrench set 0.35 Nm. Later removal of terminators must done
with extreme care, to avoid damages at the RF front connectors of the modules.

NOTE
DUAMCO: If no RX and RXCA connector is used, the connectors need not to be terminated. If at least one RX or RXCA connector is used, it is necessary to terminate all unused RX# connectors with a 50 Ohm SMC load resistor and RXCA# connectors with a
50 Ohm SMA load resistor. In normal operation all open TX# inputs need not to be terminated.
DIAMCO: If no RX and RXCA connector is used, the connectors need not to be terminated. If at least one RX or RXCA connector is used, it is necessary to terminate all unused RX# connectors and RXCA# connectors with a 50 Ohm load resistors.
FICOM: In normal operation all open TX connectors need not to be terminated. An open
expansion connector RF EXP has to be terminated with the terminator delivered with
the FICOM base module.

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

179

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

2.11

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Post Installation Notes


The following instructions must carried before leaving the site:
At the end of the working day enable any alarms that should be active.
Contact the Network Control Center to announce your departure.
Close and lock the rack doors.
Ensure the site is secure or hand over to the person in charge / caretaker
If all installation activities are finished, any garbage must be cleared from site. Remove
all packing material for recycling.

2.11.1

WARNING
The burning of rubbish should be avoided, as a burning of packaging material may give
off toxic gases.

NOTE
For dehydrating the rack during transportation and storage, a bag filled with Silica Gel
is fitted into the rack by the factory. It is recommended to remove the bag, because after
a certain time the bag lost his function.

Disposal of Electrical and Electronic Equipment

The correct disposal and separate collection of your old appliance will help prevent
potential negative consequences for the environment and human health. It is a precondition for reuse and recycling of used electrical and electronic equipment.
For more detailed information about disposal of your old appliance, please contact your
sales representative.
The statements quoted above are only fully valid for equipment which is installed in the
countries of the European Union and is covered by the directive 2002/96/EC.
Countries outside the European Union may have other regulations regarding the
disposal of electrical and electronic equipment.
All electrical and electronic products should be disposed of separately from the
municipal waste stream via designated collection facilities appointed by the government
or the local authorities.

180

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

3 Appendix
3.1

Installation Tools
The correct installation is carried out with the aid of the following tools:
Standard toolkit for BSS-installation H89999-B633
Tool set B89999-B148
Torque wrench set for SMA connectors (1,00 Nm)
Torque wrench set for SMC connectors (0,35 Nm)
Torque wrench 32 mm (25 Nm) for 7/16 connector mounting
Screw driver for torx screws T8, T10, T20, T25, T30, T40, T50 (length 200 mm)
Long screw driver for torx screws T30 (length 400 mm)
Engineers wrenches for M12, M42 (SW 19, 65 mm)
Ratchet with insets for nuts M4, M5, M6, M8, M10 (SW 7, 8, 10, 13, 17 mm)
Security torx bit IPR25 (delivered by OMP)
Insulated torque wrench for Torx T30 (6 Nm) and an open ended 17 mm (20 Nm) for
battery mounting
Insulated hexagonal socket screw key or ratchet (M6) for connecting DC cables to
AD panel (Service1A) and DC panels (Base and Extension)
Tool for the removal / replacement of gas filled surge arrestor in the OVPT
(C39407-A149-A6)
Screw drivers for hexagonal socket screw or hexagonal socket screw key SW 4 mm
Screw driver for slotted screw M3, M4, M5
Screw driver for pozi drive screws M3, M4, M5
Vacuum cleaner
Trimming tool for RF cables
90 offset screw driver for torx screws T20
Adjuster feed wrench M42 (SW65)
Flat spanner SW19, SW50
Trimming tool for 1/2 coaxial cables
Hot air gun (or propane/butane blow torch)
Hard hat, dust mask
4 ft step ladder
Fall protection equipment (for working in dangerous heights)
For installation of power supply, transmission equipment, antennas, cableways and
other infrastructure equipment, additional tools may be necessary.
Refer for additional information to the Tool and Testequipment Database in the Siemens
intranet: https://tte.erlm.siemens.de.

3.2

Ancillary Material
The following ancillary materials are needed:
adhesive tape
cable ties (different length)
wire end sleeves for 16 mm copper wires
cable lugs M8
paint retouch kit (Siemens Serial No. A500-C101-B261)
heat-shrink set including: heat-shrink sleeve for 1/2 coaxial cables (with adhesive
coating), cleaning tissue, heat protection tape, emery paper

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

181

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

3.3

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Technical Data of BS-240/240XL


Parameter

BS-240 / 240 II

BS-240XL / 240 XL II

overall dimensions (HxWxD)

1600 x 600 x 450 mm

2050 x 600 x 450 mm

weights:
rack (unequipped):
frame with 4 ACOM
frame with 4 CU + 2 MUCO
frame with 6 AC/DC
frame with battery set*
DC Panel

60 kg / 60 kg
40 kg / 60 kg
40 kg / 40 kg
27 kg / 35 kg
130-180 kg / 130-180 kg
10 kg

80 kg / 80 kg
40 kg / 60 kg
40 kg / 40 kg
27 kg / 35 kg
130-180 kg / 130-180 kg
10 kg

*dependend on battery type

mains input voltage (nominal): -48 Vdc


input voltage range:
-40,5 Vdc up to -57 Vdc

-48 Vdc
-40,5 Vdc up to -57 Vdc

mains input voltage (nominal):


input voltage range:
frequency (nominal):
frequency range:

3 x 230 Vac
207 Vac to 253 Vac
50 Hz
45 Hz to 65 Hz

3 x 230 Vac
207 Vac to 253 Vac
50 Hz
45 Hz to 65 Hz

AC/DC converter
nominal output power

1600 W

1600 W

power consumption:
TMA
AMCO
MUCO
CU (GSM)
ECU (Edge)
FCU
COBA
COSA
DC panel
frame
ACOM
battery set

9W
25,5 W
12,5 W
150 W per module
210 W per module
310 W per module
17 W
17 W
10 W
60 W
43 W
20 W

9W
25,5 W
12,5 W
150 W per module
210 W per module
310 W per module
17 W
17 W
10 W
60 W
43 W
20 W

location condition:

indoor

Abis link media:

wire, fibre optic, microwave

CU per single rack:

max. 8

multiple cell per BTSE

max. 12

no. of CU per Cell

1 - 12

Tab. 3.1

182

max. 12

Technical Data of BS-240 / 240 II / 240XL / 240 XL II

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Parameter
external interfaces:
TX/RX antenna
Abis interface
mains input AC
mains input DC

ground connection
external alarms
LMT
Tab. 3.1

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

BS-240 / 240 II

BS-240XL / 240 XL II

7/16, female
terminal block (120 Ohm) or
1.0/2.3 coaxial connectors female (75 Ohm)
terminal block (max. AWG 8)
terminal block (max. AWG 6), BS-240
terminal block (max. AWG 2), BS-240 II,
BS-240XL / XL II
bolt M8
spring terminal blocks
SubD 15, female, RJ45 connector

Technical Data of BS-240 / 240 II / 240XL / 240 XL II

183

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

3.4

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

Configuration Overview

PULL: IDXxxx004097
Rack: Baserack
BTS EQUIPMENT PLUS
23. March 2002

BS-240

BASE Rack

SIEMENS

AD400S2268D (Sales Unique Name)


FUSE PANEL

FAN 0

FAN 1

F: ACOM

ACOM 0

ACOM 1

ACOM 2

FAN 2

ACOM 3

FAN 3

F: CU

CU 2

DIAMCO 0 DIAMCO 1 CU 6

CU 3

FAN 4

CU 7

FAN 5

F: CORE

184

CU 1

CORE 3

Fig. 3.1

CORE 2

Cell
Configuration
ACOM no.

CORE 1

CORE 0

CU 0

CU 4

CU 5

Example for Configuration Overview (BS-240)

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

3.5

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Checklist for Base Station Installation


Check Item

Yes

No

Rack fixed to floor and wall (wall excepted in erthquake zones)


Grounding
BTS connected to ground as described in section External
Cabling Activities
Cable screens of all cables connected to ground at the cable
window of the building
Power Supply
Cross section of power supply cable sufficient
power supply connection correspondend to TNS-or TT Network
requirements
Cable window of the installation building equipped with lightning
conductor
Cross section correspondend to cable length
External Alarms
External alarm cables with braided screen
Cable screen contacted to metal lid of cable feeding module
Cable screen contacted to ground at both ends
Overvoltage protection equipment present and correct installed
PCM Cables
PCM cables with braided screen
Cable screens connected with EMI panel of rack
Cable screen contacted to ground at both ends
CSU connector for cable screens correspondend to
EMC requirements
Overvoltage protection equipment correct installed (if present)
Antenna Cables
Outer conductor of antenna cables connected to ground at
antenna window
Grounding of antenna cables between antenna and antenna window correpondend to grounding guideline
Antenna cable conductor protected against humidity at the
ground points
Tab. 3.2

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Checklist for BS-240/240XL Installation

185

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

186

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

Abbreviations

AC

Alternating Current

ACTC

Alarm Collection Terminal Connection


Board

ACTM

Alarm Collection Terminal for Base/Shelter

BSS

Base Station System

BTS

Base Transceiver Station

BTSE

Base Transceiver Station Equipment

CAN

Controller Area Network

COBA

Core Basis

COSA

Core Satellite

CU

Carrier Unit

DC

Direct Current

DIAMCO

Dual Inline Amplifier Multicoupler

DUAMCO

Duplexer Amplifier Multicoupler

DUBIAS

Duplexer Bias Path

EMI

Electromagnetic Interference

ESD

Electrostatically Sensitive Device

FICOM

FICOM

HPDU

High Power Duplexer

HX

Heat Exchanger

LE

Link Equipment

NTPM

Network Termination for PCM30

OVPT

Overvoltage Protection and Tracer

PCM

Pulse Code Modulation

RF

Radio Frequency

SBS

Siemens Base Station System

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631

187

IMN:BTSE
BS-240 / 240 II / 240 XL / 240XL II

188

Installation
Base Transceiver Station Equipment

A30808-X3247-K380-17-7631